blob: 2ce96167ed55938710aa12847afd4e8879a6f3b4 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaub3066502017-11-26 19:50:17 +01005 version 1.9
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau5c0e41b2018-11-18 22:33:00 +01007 2018/11/18
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100595. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200110
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011110. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011210.1. Limitation
11310.2. Setup
11410.2.1. Cache section
11510.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116
1171. Quick reminder about HTTP
118----------------------------
119
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100120When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
122on almost anything found in the contents.
123
124However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
125formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
126correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
127
128
1291.1. The HTTP transaction model
130-------------------------------
131
132The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100133to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100134from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
135connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136will involve a new connection :
137
138 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
139
140In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
141establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
142by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
143length.
144
145Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
146to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
147however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
148response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
149header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
154power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
155but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200156a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100158Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
160second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
161page :
162
163 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
164
165This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
166latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
167correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
168the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100169server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100171The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
172time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
173are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
174parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
175carry the stream identifier.
176
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100177By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
178connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
179leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100180start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
181processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
182waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200183
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200184HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100185 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
186 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
187 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100188 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200189 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100191For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
192the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
194is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
195servers.
196
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197
1981.2. HTTP request
199-----------------
200
201First, let's consider this HTTP request :
202
203 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100204 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
206 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
207 3 User-agent: my small browser
208 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
209 5 Accept: image/png
210
211
2121.2.1. The Request line
213-----------------------
214
215Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
216
217 - a METHOD : GET
218 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
219 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
220
221All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
222which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
223followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
224is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
225desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
226the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
227
228The URI itself can have several forms :
229
230 - A "relative URI" :
231
232 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
233
234 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
235 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
236
237 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
238
239 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
240
241 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
242 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
243 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
244 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
245 must accept this form too.
246
247 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
248 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
249 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100250
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200251 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
252 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
253 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
254 other protocols too.
255
256In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
257mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
258on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
259It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
260specific to the language, framework or application in use.
261
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100262HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100263assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100264However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
265received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
266processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
267as well as in server logs.
268
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200269
2701.2.2. The request headers
271--------------------------
272
273The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
274beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
275an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
276Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
277values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
278encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
279the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
280define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
281
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100282Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200283their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100284"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
285as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200286
287The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
288that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
289is one valid form of empty line.
290
291Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
292headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
293about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
294application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
295
296Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000297 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200298 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
299 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
300 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
301
302
3031.3. HTTP response
304------------------
305
306An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
307messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
308
309 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100310 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
312 2 Content-length: 350
313 3 Content-Type: text/html
314
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200315As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
316codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
317response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100318continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
319the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
320following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
321sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
322(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
323correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
324such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
325state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
326over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
327if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
328information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200329
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200330
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003311.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200332------------------------
333
334Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
335
336 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
337 - a status code : 200
338 - a reason : OK
339
340The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
342 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
343 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
344 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
345 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000347Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100348"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200349found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
350messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
351or "Authentication Required".
352
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100353HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200354
355 Code When / reason
356 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
357 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
358 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
359 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100360 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
361 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362 400 for an invalid or too large request
363 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
364 accessing the stats page)
365 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
366 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
367 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
368 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
369 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
370 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
371 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
372 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
373 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
374
375The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3764.2).
377
378
3791.3.2. The response headers
380---------------------------
381
382Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
383the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
384details.
385
386
3872. Configuring HAProxy
388----------------------
389
3902.1. Configuration file format
391------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200392
393HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
394
395 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
396 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
397 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
398 "frontend" and "backend".
399
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100400The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
401referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200402delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100403
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200404
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004052.2. Quoting and escaping
406-------------------------
407
408HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
409many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
410with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
411single quotes.
412
413If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
414them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
415escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
416
417Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
418
419 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
420 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
421 \\ to use a backslash
422 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
423 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
424
425Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
426the interpretation of:
427
428 space as a parameter separator
429 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
430 # hash as a comment start
431
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
433-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
434backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
435
436Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200437quoting.
438
439Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
440nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
441
442Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
443equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
444
445 Example:
446 # those are equivalents:
447 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
448 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
449 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
450 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
451 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
452
453 # those are equivalents:
454 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
455 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
458
459
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004602.3. Environment variables
461--------------------------
462
463HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
464interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
465configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
466optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
467shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
468underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
469
470 Example:
471
472 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
473
474 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
475
476 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
477
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200478A special variable $HAPROXY_LOCALPEER is defined at the startup of the process
479which contains the name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
480
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200481
4822.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200483----------------
484
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100485Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100486values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
487otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
488numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
489for every keyword. Supported units are :
490
491 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
492 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
493 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
494 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
495 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
496 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
497
498
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00004992.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200500-------------
501
502 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
503 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
504 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
505 global
506 daemon
507 maxconn 256
508
509 defaults
510 mode http
511 timeout connect 5000ms
512 timeout client 50000ms
513 timeout server 50000ms
514
515 frontend http-in
516 bind *:80
517 default_backend servers
518
519 backend servers
520 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
521
522
523 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
524 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
525 global
526 daemon
527 maxconn 256
528
529 defaults
530 mode http
531 timeout connect 5000ms
532 timeout client 50000ms
533 timeout server 50000ms
534
535 listen http-in
536 bind *:80
537 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
538
539
540Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
541
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100542 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200543
544
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005453. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200546--------------------
547
548Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
549are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
550of them have command-line equivalents.
551
552The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
553
554 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200555 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200557 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200558 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200559 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200560 - description
561 - deviceatlas-json-file
562 - deviceatlas-log-level
563 - deviceatlas-separator
564 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900565 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200566 - gid
567 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100568 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200569 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200570 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100571 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200572 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200573 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200574 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200575 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200576 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100577 - presetenv
578 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200579 - uid
580 - ulimit-n
581 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100582 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200583 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200584 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200585 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200586 - ssl-default-bind-options
587 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200588 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - ssl-default-server-options
590 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100591 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100592 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100593 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100594 - 51degrees-data-file
595 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200596 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200597 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100598 - wurfl-data-file
599 - wurfl-information-list
600 - wurfl-information-list-separator
601 - wurfl-engine-mode
602 - wurfl-cache-size
603 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100604
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200606 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200607 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200608 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100609 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100610 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100611 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200612 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200613 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200614 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200615 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200616 - noepoll
617 - nokqueue
618 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100619 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300620 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000621 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100622 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200623 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200624 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200625 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000626 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000627 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200628 - tune.buffers.limit
629 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200630 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200631 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100632 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200633 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200634 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200635 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100636 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200637 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200638 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100639 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100640 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100641 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100642 - tune.lua.session-timeout
643 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200644 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100645 - tune.maxaccept
646 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200647 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200648 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200649 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100650 - tune.rcvbuf.client
651 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100652 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200653 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100654 - tune.sndbuf.client
655 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100656 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100657 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200658 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100659 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200660 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200661 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100662 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200663 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100664 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200665 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
666 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
667 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100668 - tune.zlib.memlevel
669 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100670
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200671 * Debugging
672 - debug
673 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200674
675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006763.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200677------------------------------------
678
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200679ca-base <dir>
680 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200681 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
682 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200683
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200684chroot <jail dir>
685 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
686 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
687 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
688 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
689 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100690 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100691
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100692cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
693 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
694 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
695 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
696 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
697 set. These sets have the format
698
699 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
700
701 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100702 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100703 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
704 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100705 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
706 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100707 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100708 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100709 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100710 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100711 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
712 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
713 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
714 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100715
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100716 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
717 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
718 on the machine's word size.
719
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100720 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100721 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
722 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
723 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
724 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
725 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
726 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100727
728 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100729 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
730
731 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
732 # first 4 CPUs
733
734 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
735 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
736 # word size.
737
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100738 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100739 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100740 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
741 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
742 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
743
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100744 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
745 # and so on.
746 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
747 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
748 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
749
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100750 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100751 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
752 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
753 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
754
755 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
756 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
757 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
758
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100759 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
760 # and a thread range.
761 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
762 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
763 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
764
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200765crt-base <dir>
766 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
767 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
768 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
769
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200770daemon
771 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
772 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100773 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
774 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200775
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200776deviceatlas-json-file <path>
777 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100778 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200779
780deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100781 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200782 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
783
784deviceatlas-separator <char>
785 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
786 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
787
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100788deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200789 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
790 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
791 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100792
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900793external-check
794 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
795 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
796 See "option external-check".
797
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200798gid <number>
799 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
800 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
801 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100802 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
803 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200804 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100805
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100806hard-stop-after <time>
807 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
808
809 Arguments :
810 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
811 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
812 SIGUSR1 signal.
813
814 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
815 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
816 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
817
818 Example:
819 global
820 hard-stop-after 30s
821
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200822group <group name>
823 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
824 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100825
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200826log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100827 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100828 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100829 configured with "log global".
830
831 <address> can be one of:
832
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100833 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100834 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
835 port).
836
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100837 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
838 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
839 port).
840
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100841 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100842 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
843 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100844 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100845
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100846 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
847 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
848 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
849 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
850 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
851 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
852 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
853 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
854 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
855 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
856 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
857 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
858 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
859 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100860 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
861 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100862
863 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
864 "fd@2", see above.
865
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200866 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
867 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100868
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200869 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
870 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
871 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
872 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
873 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
874 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
875 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
876 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
877 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
878 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100879 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
880 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200881
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200882 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
883 one of the following :
884
885 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
886 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
887
888 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
889 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
890
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100891 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
892 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
893 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
894 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
895 logger consumes.
896
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100897 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
898 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
899 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
900 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
901
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100902 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200903
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100904 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
905 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
906 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
907
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100908 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
909 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
910 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
911 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200912
913 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200914 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
915 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
916 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
917 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
918 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
919 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200920
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200921 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200922
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100923log-send-hostname [<string>]
924 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
925 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
926 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
927 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
928 the logs.
929
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000930log-tag <string>
931 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
932 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
933 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100934 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000935
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100936lua-load <file>
937 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
938 used multiple times.
939
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100940master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200941 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
942 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
943 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100944 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200945 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
946 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100947 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
948 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
949 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
950 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
951 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200952
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100953 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200954
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200955nbproc <number>
956 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
957 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
958 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
959 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
960 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
961
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200962nbthread <number>
963 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
964 creates <number> threads for each created processes. It means if HAProxy is
965 started in foreground, it only creates <number> threads for the first
966 process. FOR NOW, THREADS SUPPORT IN HAPROXY IS HIGHLY EXPERIMENTAL AND IT
967 MUST BE ENABLED WITH CAUTION AND AT YOUR OWN RISK. See also "nbproc".
968
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200969pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100970 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200971 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
972 starting the process. See also "daemon".
973
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100974presetenv <name> <value>
975 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
976 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
977 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
978 and "unsetenv".
979
980resetenv [<name> ...]
981 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
982 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
983 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
984 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
985 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
986 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
987 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
988 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
989
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100990stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200991 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
992 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
993 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
994 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
995 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
996 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100997 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100998 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
999 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1000 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1001 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001002
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001003server-state-base <directory>
1004 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001005 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1006 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001007
1008server-state-file <file>
1009 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1010 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1011 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1012 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1013 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1014 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1015 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1016 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001017 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1018 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001019
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001020setenv <name> <value>
1021 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1022 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1023 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1024 and "unsetenv".
1025
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001026ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1027 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1028 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001029 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake except for TLSv1.3 for all
1030 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
1031 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance
1032 a string such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). For
1033 TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites"
1034 keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1035
1036ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1037 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1038 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1039 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1040 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1041 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
1042 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites", and can
1043 be for instance a string such as
1044 "TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256"
1045 (without quotes). For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check
1046 the "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
1047 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001048
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001049ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1050 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1051 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1052 keyword to see available options.
1053
1054 Example:
1055 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001056 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001057
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001058ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1059 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1060 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001061 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake except for TLSv1.3 with the server,
1062 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
1063 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration,
1064 please check the "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the
1065 "server" keyword for more information.
1066
1067ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1068 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1069 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1070 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1071 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1072 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
1073 "man 1 ciphers" under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration for
1074 TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword.
1075 Please check the "server" keyword for more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001076
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001077ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1078 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1079 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1080 keyword to see available options.
1081
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001082ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1083 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1084 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1085 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001086 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001087 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001088 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1089 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1090 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1091 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001092 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1093 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1094 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1095
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001096ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1097 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1098 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1099 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1100
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001101stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1102 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1103 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1104 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001105 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001106 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001107
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001108 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1109 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1110 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001111
1112stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1113 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1114 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001115 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001116
1117stats maxconn <connections>
1118 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1119 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1120
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001121uid <number>
1122 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1123 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1124 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1125 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1126
1127ulimit-n <number>
1128 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1129 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1130 option.
1131
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001132unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1133 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1134
1135 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1136 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1137 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1138 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1139 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1140 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1141 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1142 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1143 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1144 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1145
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001146unsetenv [<name> ...]
1147 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1148 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1149 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1150 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1151 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1152 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1153 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1154
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001155user <user name>
1156 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1157 See also "uid" and "group".
1158
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001159node <name>
1160 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1161
1162 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1163 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1164 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1165 traffic.
1166
1167description <text>
1168 Add a text that describes the instance.
1169
1170 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1171 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1172 "<" and ">" characters.
1173
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100117451degrees-data-file <file path>
1175 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001176 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001177
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001178 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001179 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1180
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000118151degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001182 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1183 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1184 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1185
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001186 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001187 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1188
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200118951degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001190 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1191 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1192
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001193 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1194 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1195
119651degrees-cache-size <number>
1197 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1198 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1199 By default, this cache is disabled.
1200
1201 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001202 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1203
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001204wurfl-data-file <file path>
1205 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1206 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1207
1208 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1209 with USE_WURFL=1.
1210
1211wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1212 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1213 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1214 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1215
1216 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1217
1218 Valid WURFL properties are:
1219 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1220
1221 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1222 device.
1223
1224 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1225 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1226
1227 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1228 particular web request.
1229
1230 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1231 used Libwurfl API version.
1232
1233 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1234 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1235 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1236
1237 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1238 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1239
1240 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1241 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1242
1243 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1244
1245 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1246
1247 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1248 with USE_WURFL=1.
1249
1250wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1251 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1252 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1253
1254 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1255 with USE_WURFL=1.
1256
1257wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1258 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1259 thus before the chroot.
1260
1261 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1262 with USE_WURFL=1.
1263
1264wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1265 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1266 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001267 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001268 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001269 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001270 mode is enabled by default.
1271
1272 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1273 with USE_WURFL=1.
1274
1275wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1276 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1277 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1278 - "0" : no cache is used.
1279 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1280 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1281 the highest performing option.
1282
1283 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1284 with USE_WURFL=1.
1285
1286wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1287 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1288 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1289
1290 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1291 with USE_WURFL=1.
1292
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012943.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001295-----------------------
1296
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001297max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1298 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1299 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1300 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1301 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1302 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1303 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1304 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1305 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1306
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001307maxconn <number>
1308 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1309 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1310 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001311 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1312 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1313 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1314 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001315 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1316 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1317 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1318 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1319 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001320
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001321maxconnrate <number>
1322 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1323 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1324 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1325 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1326 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1327 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1328 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1329 fairness.
1330
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001331maxcomprate <number>
1332 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001333 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001334 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1335 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1336 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001337 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001338 default value.
1339
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001340maxcompcpuusage <number>
1341 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1342 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1343 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1344 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1345 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1346 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1347 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1348 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1349
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001350maxpipes <number>
1351 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1352 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1353 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1354 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1355 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1356 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1357
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001358maxsessrate <number>
1359 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1360 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1361 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1362 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1363 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1364 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1365 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1366 fairness.
1367
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001368maxsslconn <number>
1369 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1370 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1371 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1372 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1373 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1374 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1375 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001376 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1377 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1378 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1379 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1380 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1381 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1382 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001383
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001384maxsslrate <number>
1385 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1386 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1387 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1388 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1389 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1390 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1391 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1392 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1393 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1394 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1395
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001396maxzlibmem <number>
1397 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1398 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1399 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001400 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1401 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1402 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1403
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001404noepoll
1405 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1406 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001407 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001408
1409nokqueue
1410 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1411 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1412 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1413
1414nopoll
1415 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1416 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001417 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001418 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001419
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001420nosplice
1421 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001422 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001423 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001424 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001425 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1426 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1427 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1428 "option splice-response".
1429
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001430nogetaddrinfo
1431 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1432 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1433
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001434noreuseport
1435 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1436 command line argument "-dR".
1437
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001438profiling.tasks { on | off }
1439 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. CPU profiling per
1440 task can be very convenient to report where the time is spent and which
1441 requests have what effect on which other request. It is not enabled by
1442 default as it may consume a little bit extra CPU. This requires a system
1443 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1444 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1445 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1446 CLI.
1447
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001448spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001449 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1450 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1451 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1452 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1453 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1454 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001455
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001456ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001457 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001458 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001459 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1460 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1461 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1462 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1463 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001464 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1465 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001466 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1467 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1468 openssl configuration file uses:
1469 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1470
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001471ssl-mode-async
1472 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001473 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001474 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1475 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1476 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1477 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1478 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001479
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001480tune.buffers.limit <number>
1481 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1482 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1483 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1484 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1485 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001486 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001487 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1488 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1489 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1490 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1491 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1492 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1493 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1494 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1495 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1496
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001497tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1498 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1499 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1500 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1501 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1502
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001503tune.bufsize <number>
1504 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1505 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1506 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1507 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1508 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1509 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1510 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001511 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1512 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1513 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001514 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1515 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001516
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001517tune.chksize <number>
1518 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1519 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1520 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1521 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1522 checks whenever possible.
1523
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001524tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1525 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1526 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1527 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1528 this value. The default value is 1.
1529
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001530tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1531 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1532 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1533 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1534 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1535 change it.
1536
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001537tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1538 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001539 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1540 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001541 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1542 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1543 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1544 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1545 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1546
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001547tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1548 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1549 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1550 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1551 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1552 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1553 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1554 recommended not to change this value.
1555
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001556tune.http.cookielen <number>
1557 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1558 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1559 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1560 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1561 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1562 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1563 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1564 to change this value.
1565
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001566tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001567 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1568 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001569 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001570 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001571 configuration directives too.
1572 The default value is 1024.
1573
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001574tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1575 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1576 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1577 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1578 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1579 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1580 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001581 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1582 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1583 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001584
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001585tune.idletimer <timeout>
1586 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1587 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1588 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1589 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1590 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1591 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001592 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001593 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1594 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1595
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001596tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1597 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001598 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001599 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1600 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001601 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001602 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1603 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1604
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001605tune.lua.maxmem
1606 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1607 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1608 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1609 memory.
1610
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001611tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1612 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001613 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1614 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001615 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001616
1617tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1618 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1619 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1620 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1621 check servers.
1622
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001623tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1624 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1625 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1626 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001627 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001628
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001629tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001630 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1631 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1632 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1633 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1634 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1635 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1636 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1637 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1638 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1639 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001640
1641tune.maxpollevents <number>
1642 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1643 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1644 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1645 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1646 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1647
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001648tune.maxrewrite <number>
1649 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1650 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1651 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1652 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1653 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1654 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1655 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1656 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1657 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1658 bufsize.
1659
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001660tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1661 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1662 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1663 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1664 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1665 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1666 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1667 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1668 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1669 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1670 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1671 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1672 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1673 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1674 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1675 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1676 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1677 setting this parameter to 0.
1678
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001679tune.pipesize <number>
1680 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1681 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1682 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1683 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1684 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1685 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1686
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001687tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1688tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1689 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1690 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1691 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1692 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001693 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001694 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1695 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1696
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001697tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001698 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001699 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1700 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1701 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1702 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1703
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001704tune.runqueue-depth <number>
1705 Sets the maxinum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
1706 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1707 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1708
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001709tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1710tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1711 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1712 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1713 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1714 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001715 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001716 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1717 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1718 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1719 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1720 notifying haproxy again.
1721
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001722tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001723 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1724 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1725 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001726 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001727 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001728 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001729 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1730 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1731 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001732 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1733 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001734
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001735tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001736 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001737 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1738 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1739 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1740 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1741 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1742
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001743tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1744 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001745 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001746 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1747 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1748 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1749 being used for too long.
1750
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001751tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1752 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1753 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1754 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1755 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1756 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1757 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1758 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1759 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1760 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1761 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001762 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001763 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001764
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001765tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1766 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1767 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1768 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1769 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1770 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1771 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1772 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001773 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1774 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001775
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001776tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1777 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1778 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1779 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1780 1000 entries.
1781
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001782tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1783 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1784 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1785 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1786
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001787tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001788tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001789tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1790tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1791tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001792 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1793 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1794 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1795 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1796 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1797 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1798 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1799 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001800
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001801 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1802 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1803 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1804 all available space is consumed.
1805 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1806 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1807 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001808
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001809tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1810 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001811 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001812 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001813 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001814 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1815
1816tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1817 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1818 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001819 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1820 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001821
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018223.3. Debugging
1823--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001824
1825debug
1826 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1827 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1828 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1829 system startup.
1830
1831quiet
1832 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1833 line argument "-q".
1834
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001835
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018363.4. Userlists
1837--------------
1838It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1839http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1840it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1841
1842userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001843 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001844 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1845
1846group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001847 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001848 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1849 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1850
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001851user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1852 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001853 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1854 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001855 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1856 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1857 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1858 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001859
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001860 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1861 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1862 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1863 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1864 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1865 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1866 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1867 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1868 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001869
1870 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001871 userlist L1
1872 group G1 users tiger,scott
1873 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001874
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001875 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1876 user scott insecure-password elgato
1877 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001878
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001879 userlist L2
1880 group G1
1881 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001882
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001883 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1884 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1885 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001886
1887 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001888
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001889
18903.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001891----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001892It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1893several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1894instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1895values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1896automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1897In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1898using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1899tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1900reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1901Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1902that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1903each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001904
1905peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001906 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001907 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1908
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001909disabled
1910 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1911 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1912 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1913
1914enable
1915 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1916
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001917peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1918 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1919 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1920 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1921 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1922 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1923 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1924
1925 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1926 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1927
1928 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1929 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1930 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1931 across all peers.
1932
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001933 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1934 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001935
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001936 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001937 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001938 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1939 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1940 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001941
1942 backend mybackend
1943 mode tcp
1944 balance roundrobin
1945 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1946 stick on src
1947
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001948 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1949 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001950
1951
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090019523.6. Mailers
1953------------
1954It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1955If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1956in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1957
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001958mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001959 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1960 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1961
1962mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1963 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1964
1965 Example:
1966 mailers mymailers
1967 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1968 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1969
1970 backend mybackend
1971 mode tcp
1972 balance roundrobin
1973
1974 email-alert mailers mymailers
1975 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1976 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1977
1978 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1979 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1980
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001981timeout mail <time>
1982 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1983 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1984 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1985 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1986
1987 Example:
1988 mailers mymailers
1989 timeout mail 20s
1990 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001991
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019924. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001993----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001994
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001995Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001996 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001997 - frontend <name>
1998 - backend <name>
1999 - listen <name>
2000
2001A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2002its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2003section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002004section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002005
2006A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2007connections.
2008
2009A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2010to forward incoming connections.
2011
2012A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2013parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2014
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002015All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2016'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2017case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2018
2019Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2020logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2021proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2022However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2023name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2024
2025Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2026and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002027bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002028protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2029modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2030arbitrary criteria.
2031
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002032In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2033a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002034the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002035
2036 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2037 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2038 between responses and new requests.
2039
2040 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2041 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2042 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02002043 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing. It
2044 is supported only on frontends.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002045
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002046 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2047 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2048 client-facing connection remains open.
2049
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002050 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2051 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002052
2053The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2054frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2055following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002056weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002057
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002058 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002059
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002060 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2061 ----+-----+-----+----
2062 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2063 ----+-----+-----+----
2064 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2065 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2066 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2067 ----+-----+-----+----
2068 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002069
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002070
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002071
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020724.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2073--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002074
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002075The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2076limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2077they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2078limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002079marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002080option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002081and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2082with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2083specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002084
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002085
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002086 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2087------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2088acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002089appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002090backlog X X X -
2091balance X - X X
2092bind - X X -
2093bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002094block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002095capture cookie - X X -
2096capture request header - X X -
2097capture response header - X X -
2098clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002099compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002100contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2101cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002102declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002103default-server X - X X
2104default_backend X X X -
2105description - X X X
2106disabled X X X X
2107dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002108email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002109email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002110email-alert mailers X X X X
2111email-alert myhostname X X X X
2112email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002113enabled X X X X
2114errorfile X X X X
2115errorloc X X X X
2116errorloc302 X X X X
2117-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2118errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002119force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002120filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002121fullconn X - X X
2122grace X X X X
2123hash-type X - X X
2124http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002125http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002126http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002127http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002128http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002129http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002130http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002131id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002132ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002133load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002134log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002135log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002136log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002137log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002138max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002139maxconn X X X -
2140mode X X X X
2141monitor fail - X X -
2142monitor-net X X X -
2143monitor-uri X X X -
2144option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2145option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2146option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2147option allbackups (*) X - X X
2148option checkcache (*) X - X X
2149option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2150option contstats (*) X X X -
2151option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2152option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002153option forceclose (deprectated) (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002154-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2155option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002156option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002157option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002158option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002159option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002160option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002161option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02002162option http-tunnel (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002163option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002164option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002165option httpchk X - X X
2166option httpclose (*) X X X X
2167option httplog X X X X
2168option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002169option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002170option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002171option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002172option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2173option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2174option logasap (*) X X X -
2175option mysql-check X - X X
2176option nolinger (*) X X X X
2177option originalto X X X X
2178option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002179option pgsql-check X - X X
2180option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002181option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002182option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002183option smtpchk X - X X
2184option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2185option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2186option splice-request (*) X X X X
2187option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002188option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002189option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2190option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2191-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002192option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002193option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2194option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2195option tcpka X X X X
2196option tcplog X X X X
2197option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002198external-check command X - X X
2199external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002200persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2201rate-limit sessions X X X -
2202redirect - X X X
2203redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2204redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2205reqadd - X X X
2206reqallow - X X X
2207reqdel - X X X
2208reqdeny - X X X
2209reqiallow - X X X
2210reqidel - X X X
2211reqideny - X X X
2212reqipass - X X X
2213reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002214reqitarpit - X X X
2215reqpass - X X X
2216reqrep - X X X
2217-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002218reqtarpit - X X X
2219retries X - X X
2220rspadd - X X X
2221rspdel - X X X
2222rspdeny - X X X
2223rspidel - X X X
2224rspideny - X X X
2225rspirep - X X X
2226rsprep - X X X
2227server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002228server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002229server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002230source X - X X
2231srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002232stats admin - X X X
2233stats auth X X X X
2234stats enable X X X X
2235stats hide-version X X X X
2236stats http-request - X X X
2237stats realm X X X X
2238stats refresh X X X X
2239stats scope X X X X
2240stats show-desc X X X X
2241stats show-legends X X X X
2242stats show-node X X X X
2243stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002244-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2245stick match - - X X
2246stick on - - X X
2247stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002248stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002249stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002250tcp-check connect - - X X
2251tcp-check expect - - X X
2252tcp-check send - - X X
2253tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002254tcp-request connection - X X -
2255tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002256tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002257tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002258tcp-response content - - X X
2259tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002260timeout check X - X X
2261timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002262timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002263timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2264timeout connect X - X X
2265timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2266timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2267timeout http-request X X X X
2268timeout queue X - X X
2269timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002270timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002271timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2272timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002273timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002274transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002275unique-id-format X X X -
2276unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002277use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002278use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002279------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2280 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002281
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002282
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022834.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2284---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002285
2286This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2287
2288
2289acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2290 Declare or complete an access list.
2291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2292 no | yes | yes | yes
2293 Example:
2294 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2295 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2296 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2297
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002298 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002299
2300
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002301appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2302 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002303 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2305 no | no | yes | yes
2306 Arguments :
2307 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2308 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2309
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002310 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002311 checked in each cookie value.
2312
2313 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2314 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2315 milliseconds.
2316
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002317 request-learn
2318 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2319 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2320 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2321 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2322 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2323 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2324
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002325 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2326 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2327 data following this prefix.
2328
2329 Example :
2330 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2331
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002332 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXX=XXXX,
2333 the appsession value will be XXX=XXXX.
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002334
2335 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2336 2 modes are currently supported :
2337 - path-parameters :
2338 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2339 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2340 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2341 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2342 - query-string :
2343 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2344 query string.
2345
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002346 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2347 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2348 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002349
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002350 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2351 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002352
2353
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002354backlog <conns>
2355 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2357 yes | yes | yes | no
2358 Arguments :
2359 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2360 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002361 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002362
2363 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2364 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2365 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2366 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2367 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2368 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2369 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2370 backlog parameter.
2371
2372 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2373 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2374 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2375
2376 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2377
2378
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002379balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002380balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002381 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2383 yes | no | yes | yes
2384 Arguments :
2385 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2386 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2387 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2388 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2389
2390 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2391 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2392 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2393 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002394 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002395 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002396 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2397 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2398 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2399 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2400 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2401 it, so that you don't worry.
2402
2403 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2404 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2405 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2406 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2407 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2408 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2409 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2410 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002411
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002412 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2413 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2414 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2415 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2416 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2417 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2418 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2419 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2420
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002421 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002422 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002423 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2424 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002425 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002426 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2427 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2428 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2429 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2430 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002431 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2432 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2433 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2434 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2435 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2436 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002437
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002438 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2439 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2440 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2441 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2442 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2443 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2444 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2445 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002446 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002447 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002448 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2449 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2450 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002451
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002452 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2453 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2454 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2455 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2456 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2457 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2458 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2459 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2460 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2461 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2462 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2463 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002464
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002465 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002466 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2467 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2468 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2469 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2470 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2471 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2472 URIs start with a leading "/".
2473
2474 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2475 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2476 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2477 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2478
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002479 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002480 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2481
2482 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002483 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2484 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002485 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2486 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2487 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2488 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002489 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002490 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2491 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002492
2493 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2494 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2495 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2496 server will receive the request.
2497
2498 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2499 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2500 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2501 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2502 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002503 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2504 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2505 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002506
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002507 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2508 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2509 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2510 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2511 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002512
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002513 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002514 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2515 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2516 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2517
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002518 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2519 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2520 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2521
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002522 random A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
2523 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2524 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2525 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2526 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
2527 or removed. The hash-balance-factor directive can be used to
2528 further improve fairness of the load balancing, especially
2529 in situations where servers show highly variable response
2530 times.
2531
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002532 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002533 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002534 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2535 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2536 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2537 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2538 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2539 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002540 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002541 used instead.
2542
2543 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2544 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2545 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2546 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2547
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002548 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2549 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2550 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2551
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002552 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002553
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002554 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002555 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2556 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002557
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002558 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2559 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2560 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002561
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002562 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
2563 based alghoritms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
2564 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2565 NTLM relies on.
2566
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002567 Examples :
2568 balance roundrobin
2569 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002570 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002571 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2572 balance hdr(host)
2573 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002574
2575 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2576 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2577
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002578 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002579 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2580 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2581 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2582 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2583
2584 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2585 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2586 defaults to 16 kB.
2587
2588 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2589 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2590
2591 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2592 Round Robin.
2593
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002594 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002595 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2596 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2597 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2598
2599 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2600
2601 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002602 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002603 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2604 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2605 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002606
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002607 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002608
2609
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002610bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2611bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002612 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2614 no | yes | yes | no
2615 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002616 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2617 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2618 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2619 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002620 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002621 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2622 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2623 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2624 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2625 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2626 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2627 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002628 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2629 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2630 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2631 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2632 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2633 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2634 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002635 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2636 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2637 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002638 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2639 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2640 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2641 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002642 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2643 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2644 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002645
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002646 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2647 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002648 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2649 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2650 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002651 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2652 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2653 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2654 the range.
2655
2656 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2657 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2658 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2659 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2660 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2661 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2662 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002663 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002664 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002665
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002666 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002667 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002668 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2669 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2670 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2671 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2672 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2673 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2674
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002675 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2676 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2677 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2678 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002679
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002680 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2681 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2682 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2683 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2684 in a frontend.
2685
2686 Example :
2687 listen http_proxy
2688 bind :80,:443
2689 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002690 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002691
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002692 listen http_https_proxy
2693 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002694 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002695
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002696 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2697 bind ipv6@:80
2698 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2699 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2700
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002701 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002702 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002703
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002704 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2705 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2706 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2707 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2708 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2709
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002710 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002711 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002712
2713
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002714bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002715 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2717 yes | yes | yes | yes
2718 Arguments :
2719 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2720 may be used to override a default value.
2721
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002722 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002723 option may be combined with other numbers.
2724
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002725 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002726 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2727 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2728 missing from all processes.
2729
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002730 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002731 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002732 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2733 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2734 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2735 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2736 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002737 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002738
2739 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2740 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2741 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2742 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2743 and 'even' instances.
2744
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002745 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2746 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2747 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2748 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002749
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002750 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2751 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2752
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002753 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2754 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2755 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2756
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002757 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2758 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2759
2760 Example :
2761 listen app_ip1
2762 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002763 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002764
2765 listen app_ip2
2766 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002767 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002768
2769 listen management
2770 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002771 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002772
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002773 listen management
2774 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2775 bind-process 1-4
2776
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002777 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002778
2779
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002780block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002781 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2783 no | yes | yes | yes
2784
2785 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2786 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002787 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002788 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002789 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002790 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2791 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2792 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002793
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002794 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2795 "http-request deny" instead.
2796
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002797 Example:
2798 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2799 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2800 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002801 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2802 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2803 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002804
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002805 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2806 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2807 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002808
2809capture cookie <name> len <length>
2810 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2812 no | yes | yes | no
2813 Arguments :
2814 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2815 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2816 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2817 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002818 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002819
2820 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2821 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2822 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2823 right if it exceeds <length>.
2824
2825 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2826 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2827 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2828 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2829
2830 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2831 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2832 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2833
2834 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2835 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2836 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002837 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2838 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2839 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002840
2841 Example:
2842 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2843
2844 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002845 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002846
2847
2848capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002849 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2851 no | yes | yes | no
2852 Arguments :
2853 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002854 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002855 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2856 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2857 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2858
2859 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2860 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2861 it exceeds <length>.
2862
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002863 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002864 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2865 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002866 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2867 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2868 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2869 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002870 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002871 environments to find where the request came from.
2872
2873 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2874 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2875 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2876 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002877
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002878 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2879 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2880 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2881 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2882 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002883
2884 Example:
2885 capture request header Host len 15
2886 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002887 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002888
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002889 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002890 about logging.
2891
2892
2893capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002894 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2896 no | yes | yes | no
2897 Arguments :
2898 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002899 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002900 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2901 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2902 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2903
2904 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2905 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2906 it exceeds <length>.
2907
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002908 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002909 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2910 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2911 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002912 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2913 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2914 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2915 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002916
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002917 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2918 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2919 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2920 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2921 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002922
2923 Example:
2924 capture response header Content-length len 9
2925 capture response header Location len 15
2926
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002927 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002928 about logging.
2929
2930
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002931clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002932 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2934 yes | yes | yes | no
2935 Arguments :
2936 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2937 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2938 as explained at the top of this document.
2939
2940 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2941 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2942 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2943 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2944 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2945 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2946 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2947 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002948 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002949 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002950 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002951
2952 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2953 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2954 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2955 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2956 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2957 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2958
2959 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2960 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2961
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002962 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2963 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002964
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002965compression algo <algorithm> ...
2966compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002967compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002968 Enable HTTP compression.
2969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2970 yes | yes | yes | yes
2971 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002972 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2973 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2974 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2975
2976 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002977 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2978 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2979 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002980
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002981 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002982 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002983
2984 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2985 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2986 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2987 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2988 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002989 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002990
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002991 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2992 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2993 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2994 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2995 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2996 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2997 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002998 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002999
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003000 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003001 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003002 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3003 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3004 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3005 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3006 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003007
3008 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3009 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3010 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3011 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3012 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003013 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3014 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3015 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3016 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3017 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003018 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3019 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003020
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003021 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003022 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3023 "Accept-Encoding" header
3024 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01003025 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01003026 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
3027 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003028 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3029 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3030 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3031 "multipart"
3032 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3033 header
3034 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3035 and later
3036 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3037 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003038
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003039 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
3040 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003041
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003042 Examples :
3043 compression algo gzip
3044 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003045
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003046
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003047contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003048 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3050 yes | no | yes | yes
3051 Arguments :
3052 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3053 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3054 as explained at the top of this document.
3055
3056 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003057 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003058 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003059 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003060 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3061 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3062 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3063
3064 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3065 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3066 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3067 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3068 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3069 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3070
3071 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3072 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3073 instead.
3074
3075 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3076 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3077
3078
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003079cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003080 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3081 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003082 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003083 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3085 yes | no | yes | yes
3086 Arguments :
3087 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3088 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3089 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3090 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3091 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3092 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003093 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003094 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3095 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3096
3097 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3098 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3099 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3100 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3101 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3102 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003103 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3104 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003105 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003106 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3107 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003108
3109 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003110 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003111
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003112 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003113 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
3114 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003115 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003116 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3117 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3118 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3119 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3120 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3121 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3122 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003123
3124 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3125 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3126 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3127 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3128 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3129 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3130 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3131 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3132 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003133 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003134 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3135 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3136 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003137
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003138 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3139 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3140 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003141 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3142 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3143 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3144 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003145 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3146 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3147 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003148
3149 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3150 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3151 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3152 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3153 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3154 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3155 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3156 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3157 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3158
3159 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3160 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3161 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3162 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3163 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3164 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3165 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3166 persistence cookie in the cache.
3167 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3168
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003169 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3170 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3171 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3172 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3173 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003174 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003175 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3176 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3177 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3178 they logout.
3179
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003180 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3181 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3182 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3183 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3184
3185 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3186 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3187 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3188 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3189 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3190 this attribute.
3191
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003192 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003193 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003194 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3195 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3196 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3197 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3198 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3199 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003200
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003201 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3202 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3203 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3204 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3205 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3206 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3207 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3208 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003209 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003210 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3211 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3212 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3213 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3214 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3215 the site.
3216
3217 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3218 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3219 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3220 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3221 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3222 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3223 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3224 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3225 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3226 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3227 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3228 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3229 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003230 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003231 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3232 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3233
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003234 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3235 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3236 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3237 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3238 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3239 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3240
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003241 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3242 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3243 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3244 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003245
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003246 Examples :
3247 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3248 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3249 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003250 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003251
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003252 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003253
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003254
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003255declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3256 Declares a capture slot.
3257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3258 no | yes | yes | no
3259 Arguments:
3260 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3261
3262 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3263 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3264 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3265 for use in the response.
3266
3267 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003268 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003269 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3270
3271
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003272default-server [param*]
3273 Change default options for a server in a backend
3274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3275 yes | no | yes | yes
3276 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003277 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3278 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3279 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3280 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003281
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003282 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003283 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3284
3285 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003286
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003287
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003288default_backend <backend>
3289 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3291 yes | yes | yes | no
3292 Arguments :
3293 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3294
3295 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3296 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3297 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3298 will catch all undetermined requests.
3299
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003300 Example :
3301
3302 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3303 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3304 default_backend dynamic
3305
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003306 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003307
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003308
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003309description <string>
3310 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3312 no | yes | yes | yes
3313 Arguments : string
3314
3315 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3316 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3317 it describes.
3318 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3319
3320
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003321disabled
3322 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3324 yes | yes | yes | yes
3325 Arguments : none
3326
3327 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3328 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3329 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3330 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3331 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3332 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3333 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3334
3335 See also : "enabled"
3336
3337
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003338dispatch <address>:<port>
3339 Set a default server address
3340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3341 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003342 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003343
3344 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3345 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3346 during start-up.
3347
3348 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3349 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3350 possible with normal servers.
3351
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003352 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003353 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3354 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3355 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3356 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3357
3358 See also : "server"
3359
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003360
3361dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3362 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3364 yes | no | yes | yes
3365 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3366
3367 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003368 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003369 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3370 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003371 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003372 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003374enabled
3375 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3377 yes | yes | yes | yes
3378 Arguments : none
3379
3380 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3381 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3382
3383 See also : "disabled"
3384
3385
3386errorfile <code> <file>
3387 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3389 yes | yes | yes | yes
3390 Arguments :
3391 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003392 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3393 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003394
3395 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003396 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003397 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003398 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3399 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003400
3401 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3402 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3403 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3404
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003405 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3406
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003407 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3408 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3409 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3410 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3411
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003412 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3413 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003414 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003415 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3416 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3417 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3418
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003419 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3420 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3421 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003422 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003423 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3424
3425 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3426
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003427 Example :
3428 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003429 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003430 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3431 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3432
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003433
3434errorloc <code> <url>
3435errorloc302 <code> <url>
3436 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3438 yes | yes | yes | yes
3439 Arguments :
3440 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003441 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3442 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003443
3444 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3445 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3446 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3447 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003448 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003449
3450 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3451 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3452 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3453
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003454 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3455
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003456 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3457 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3458 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3459 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003460 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003461 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3462 request.
3463
3464 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3465
3466
3467errorloc303 <code> <url>
3468 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3470 yes | yes | yes | yes
3471 Arguments :
3472 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003473 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3474 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003475
3476 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3477 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3478 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3479 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003480 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003481
3482 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3483 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3484 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3485
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003486 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3487
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003488 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3489 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3490 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3491 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003492 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003493
3494 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3495
3496
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003497email-alert from <emailaddr>
3498 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003499 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003500 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3501 yes | yes | yes | yes
3502
3503 Arguments :
3504
3505 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3506
3507 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3508 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3509
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003510 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003511 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3512 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003513
3514
3515email-alert level <level>
3516 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3517 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3518 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3519 yes | yes | yes | yes
3520
3521 Arguments :
3522
3523 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3524 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3525 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3526
3527 By default level is alert
3528
3529 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3530 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3531 for the proxy.
3532
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003533 Alerts are sent when :
3534
3535 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3536 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3537 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3538 is notice or lower
3539 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3540 and a health check status update occurs
3541
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003542 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3543 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003544 section 3.6 about mailers.
3545
3546
3547email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3548 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3549 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3550 yes | yes | yes | yes
3551
3552 Arguments :
3553
3554 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3555
3556 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3557 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3558
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003559 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3560 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003561
3562
3563email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3564 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3565 mailers.
3566 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3567 yes | yes | yes | yes
3568
3569 Arguments :
3570
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003571 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003572
3573 By default the systems hostname is used.
3574
3575 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3576 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3577 for the proxy.
3578
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003579 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3580 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003581
3582
3583email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003584 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003585 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3586 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3587 yes | yes | yes | yes
3588
3589 Arguments :
3590
3591 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3592
3593 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3594 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3595
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003596 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003597 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3598
3599
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003600force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3601 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3602 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003603 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003604
3605 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3606 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3607 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3608 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3609 marked down for maintenance operations.
3610
3611 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3612 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3613 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3614 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3615 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3616 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3617 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3618 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3619 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3620
3621 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3622 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3623 is used.
3624
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003625 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003626 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003627
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003628
3629filter <name> [param*]
3630 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3632 no | yes | yes | yes
3633 Arguments :
3634 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3635 referenced in section 9.
3636
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003637 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003638 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003639 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3640 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003641
3642 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3643 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3644
3645 Example:
3646 listen
3647 bind *:80
3648
3649 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3650 filter compression
3651 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3652
3653 compression algo gzip
3654 compression offload
3655
3656 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3657
3658 See also : section 9.
3659
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003660
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003661fullconn <conns>
3662 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3664 yes | no | yes | yes
3665 Arguments :
3666 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3667 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3668
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003669 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003670 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003671 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003672 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3673 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3674 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3675 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3676 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003677 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003678
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003679 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3680 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003681 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3682 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3683 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003684
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003685 Example :
3686 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3687 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3688 # connections.
3689 backend dynamic
3690 fullconn 10000
3691 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3692 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3693
3694 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3695
3696
3697grace <time>
3698 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003700 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003701 Arguments :
3702 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3703 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3704 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3705
3706 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3707 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003708 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003709 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3710
3711 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3712 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3713 simplify it.
3714
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003715
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003716hash-balance-factor <factor>
3717 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3719 yes | no | no | yes
3720 Arguments :
3721 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3722 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3723 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3724
3725 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3726 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3727 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3728 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3729 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3730 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3731 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3732
3733 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3734 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3735 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3736 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3737 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3738
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003739 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3740 consistent hashing mechanism.
3741
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003742 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3743
3744
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003745hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003746 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3748 yes | no | yes | yes
3749 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003750 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3751 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003752
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003753 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3754 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3755 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3756 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3757 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3758 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3759 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3760 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3761 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3762 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003763
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003764 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3765 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3766 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3767 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3768 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3769 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3770 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3771 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3772 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3773 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3774 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3775 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3776 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003777 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3778 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003779
3780 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3781
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003782 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003783 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3784 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3785 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003786 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3787 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3788 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003789
3790 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3791 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003792 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3793 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3794 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3795 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3796
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003797 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3798 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3799 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3800 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3801 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3802 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3803 parameter.
3804
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003805 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3806 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3807 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3808 used on strings.
3809
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003810 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3811
3812 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3813 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3814 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3815 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3816 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3817 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3818 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3819 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3820 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3821 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3822 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3823 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003824
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003825 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3826 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3827 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003828
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003829 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003830
3831
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003832http-check disable-on-404
3833 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003835 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003836 Arguments : none
3837
3838 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3839 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3840 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3841 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3842 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3843 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3844 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3845 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003846 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3847 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3848 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3849
3850 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3851
3852
3853http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003854 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003856 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003857 Arguments :
3858 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3859 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003860 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003861 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3862 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3863 details on the supported keywords.
3864
3865 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3866 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3867 with the usual backslash ('\').
3868
3869 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3870 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3871 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3872 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3873 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3874
3875 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003876 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003877 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3878 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3879 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3880
3881 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003882 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003883 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3884 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3885 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3886 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3887
3888 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003889 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003890 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3891 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3892 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3893 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3894 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003895 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003896 trace).
3897
3898 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003899 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003900 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3901 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3902 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3903 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3904 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003905 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003906
3907 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3908 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3909 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3910 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3911 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3912 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3913 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3914 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3915
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003916 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3917 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3918 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3919
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003920 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3921 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3922
3923 Examples :
3924 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003925 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003926
3927 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003928 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003929
3930 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003931 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003932
3933 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03003934 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003935
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003936 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003937
3938
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003939http-check send-state
3940 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3942 yes | no | yes | yes
3943 Arguments : none
3944
3945 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3946 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3947 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3948 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3949 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3950
3951 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3952 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3953 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3954 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3955 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003956 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3957 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3958 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3959
3960 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3961 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3962 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3963
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003964 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3965 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3966 checked in multiple backends.
3967
3968 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3969 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3970
3971 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3972 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3973 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3974 one fails.
3975
3976 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3977 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3978 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3979
3980 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3981 server's queue.
3982
3983 Example of a header received by the application server :
3984 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3985 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3986
3987 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3988
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02003989
3990http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003991 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3992
3993 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3994 no | yes | yes | yes
3995
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003996 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3997 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3998 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3999 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4000 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004001
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004002 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4003 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004004
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004005 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004006
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004007 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4008 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4009 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4010 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004011
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004012 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4013 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4014 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4015 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004016
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004017 Example:
4018 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4019 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4020 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004021
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004022 http-request allow if nagios
4023 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4024 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4025 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004026
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004027 Example:
4028 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4029 acl add path /addacl
4030 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004031
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004032 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004033
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004034 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4035 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004036
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004037 Example:
4038 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4039 acl setmap path /setmap
4040 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004041
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004042 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004043
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004044 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4045 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004046
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004047 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4048 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004049
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004050http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004051
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004052 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4053 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4054 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4055 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4056 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4057 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4058 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4059 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004060
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004061http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004062
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004063 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4064 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4065 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4066 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4067 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4068 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4069 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4070 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004071
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004072http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004073
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004074 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4075 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004076
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004077
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004078http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004079
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004080 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4081 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4082 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4083 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4084 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004085
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004086 Example:
4087 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4088 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004089
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004090http-request cache-use [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004091
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004092 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004093
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004094http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4095 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004096
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004097 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4098 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4099 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4100 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4101 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4102 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4103 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4104 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4105 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004106
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004107 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4108 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4109 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4110 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4111 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4112 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004113
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004114http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004115
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004116 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4117 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4118 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4119 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4120 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4121 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004122
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004123http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004124
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004125 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004126
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004127http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004128
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004129 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4130 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4131 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4132 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4133 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4134 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004135
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004136http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004137
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004138 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4139 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4140 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4141 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4142 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004143
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004144http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4145
4146 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4147 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4148 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4149 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004150 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4151 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004152
4153 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4154
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004155http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004156
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004157 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4158 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4159 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4160 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4161 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004162
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004163http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004164
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004165 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4166 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4167 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4168 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004169
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004170http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4171 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004172
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004173 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field
4174 <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the
4175 <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and
4176 work like in <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header". The match is
4177 only case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4178 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they may
4179 contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas in
4180 their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004181
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004182 Example:
4183 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004184
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004185 # applied to:
4186 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004187
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004188 # outputs:
4189 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004190
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004191 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004192
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004193http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4194 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004195
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004196 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4197 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4198 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4199 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004200
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004201 Example:
4202 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004203
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004204 # applied to:
4205 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004206
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004207 # outputs:
4208 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004209
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004210http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4211http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004212
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004213 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4214 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4215 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004216
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004217http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004218
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004219 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4220 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4221 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004222
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004223http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004224
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004225 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4226 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4227 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4228 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4229 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004230
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004231 Arguments:
4232 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4233 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004234
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004235 Example:
4236 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4237 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004238
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004239 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4240 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004241
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004242http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004243
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004244 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4245 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4246 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004247
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004248 Arguments:
4249 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4250 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004251
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004252 Example:
4253 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4254 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004255
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004256 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4257 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4258 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004259
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004260http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004261
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004262 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4263 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4264 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4265 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4266 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004267
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004268 Example:
4269 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4270 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4271 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4272 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4273 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4274 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4275 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4276 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4277 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004278
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004279http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004280
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004281 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4282 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4283 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4284 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4285 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004286
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004287http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4288 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004289
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004290 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4291 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4292 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4293 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4294 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4295 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4296 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4297 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4298 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004299
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004300http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004301
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004302 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4303 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4304 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4305 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4306 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4307 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4308 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004309
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004310http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004311
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004312 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4313 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4314 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004315
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004316http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004317
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004318 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4319 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4320 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4321 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4322 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4323 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4324 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4325 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004326
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004327http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004328
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004329 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4330 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4331 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4332 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4333 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4334 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004335
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004336 Example :
4337 # prepend the host name before the path
4338 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004340http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004341
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004342 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4343 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4344 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4345 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4346 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004347
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004348http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004349
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004350 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4351 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4352 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4353 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4354 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4355 values have higher priority.
4356 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4357 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4358 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4359 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4360 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004361
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004362http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004363
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004364 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4365 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4366 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4367 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4368 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4369 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4370 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004371
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004372 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004373
4374 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004375 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4376 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004377
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004378http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4379 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4380 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4381 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4382 privacy.
4383
4384 Arguments :
4385 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4386 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004387
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004388 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004389 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4390 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4391
4392 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4393 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4394
4395http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4396
4397 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4398 expression.
4399
4400 Arguments:
4401 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4402 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004403
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004404 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004405 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4406 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4407
4408 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4409 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4410 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4411
4412http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4413
4414 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4415 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4416 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4417 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4418 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4419 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4420 information from the request.
4421
4422 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4423
4424http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4425
4426 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4427 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4428 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4429 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4430 path and the query string.
4431 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4432
4433http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4434
4435 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4436 inline.
4437
4438 Arguments:
4439 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4440 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4441 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4442 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4443 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4444 (request and response)
4445 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4446 processing
4447 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4448 processing
4449 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4450 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4451 and '_'.
4452
4453 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4454 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004455
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004456 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004457 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004458
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004459http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4460 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004461
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004462 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4463 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4464 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4465 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4466 agent name must be used.
4467
4468 Arguments:
4469 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4470
4471 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4472 configuration.
4473
4474http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4475
4476 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4477 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4478 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4479 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4480 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4481 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4482 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4483 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4484 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4485 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4486 action.
4487 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4488 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4489 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4490 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4491 you fully understand how it works.
4492
4493http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4494
4495 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4496 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4497 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4498 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4499 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4500 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4501 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4502 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4503 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4504 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4505 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4506 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4507 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4508
4509http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4510http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4511http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4512
4513 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4514 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4515 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4516 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4517 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4518 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4519 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4520 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4521 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4522 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4523 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4524 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4525
4526 Arguments :
4527 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4528 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4529 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4530 select which table entry to update the counters.
4531
4532 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4533 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4534 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4535 that table until the session ends.
4536
4537 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4538 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4539 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4540 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4541 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4542 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4543 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4544 useful information.
4545
4546 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4547 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4548 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4549 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4550 checks that make use of it.
4551
4552http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4553
4554 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004555
4556 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004557 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004558
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004559http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004560
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004561 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4562 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4563 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004564
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004565
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004566http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004567 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4568
4569 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4570 no | yes | yes | yes
4571
4572 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4573 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4574 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4575 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4576 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4577 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4578
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004579 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4580 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004581
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004582 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004583
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004584 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
4585 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4586 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4587 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004588
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004589 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4590 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4591 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4592 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004593
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004594 Example:
4595 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004596
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004597 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004598
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004599 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4600 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004601
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004602 Example:
4603 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004604
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004605 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004606
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004607 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4608 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004609
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004610 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4611 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004612
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004613http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004614
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004615 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4616 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4617 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4618 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4619 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4620 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4621 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4622 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004623
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004624http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004625
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004626 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4627 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4628 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4629 example, or to pass some internal information.
4630 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4631 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4632 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004633
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004634http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004635
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004636 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4637 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004638
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004639http-response cache-store [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004640
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004641 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004642
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004643http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004644
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004645 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4646 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4647 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4648 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4649 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4650 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4651 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004652
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004653 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4654 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4655 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4656 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4657 keyword.
4658 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4659 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004660
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004661http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004662
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004663 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4664 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4665 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4666 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4667 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4668 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004669
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004670http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004671
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004672 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004673
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004674http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004675
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004676 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4677 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4678 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4679 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4680 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4681 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004682
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004683http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004684
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004685 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4686 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004687
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004688http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004689
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004690 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4691 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4692 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4693 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4694 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4695 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004696
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004697http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4698 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004699
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004700 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field <name>
4701 according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the <replace-fmt> argument.
4702 Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and work like in <fmt> arguments
4703 in "add-header". The match is only case-sensitive. It is important to
4704 understand that this action only considers whole header lines, regardless of
4705 the number of values they may contain. This usage is suited to headers
4706 naturally containing commas in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and
4707 so on.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004708
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004709 Example:
4710 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004711
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004712 # applied to:
4713 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004714
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004715 # outputs:
4716 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004717
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004718 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004719
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004720http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4721 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004722
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004723 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4724 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the entire
4725 header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry more than
4726 one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004727
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004728 Example:
4729 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004730
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004731 # applied to:
4732 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004733
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004734 # outputs:
4735 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004736
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004737http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4738http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004739
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004740 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4741 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4742 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004743
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004744http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004745
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004746 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4747 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4748 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004749
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004750http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004751
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004752 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4753 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4754 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4755 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4756 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004757
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004758 Arguments:
4759 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004760
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004761 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4762 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004763
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004764http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004765
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004766 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4767 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4768 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004769
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004770http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4771
4772 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4773 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4774 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4775 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
4776 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
4777
4778http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4779
4780 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4781 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4782 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4783 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4784 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
4785 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4786 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4787 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
4788 be triggered by an HTTP response.
4789
4790http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4791
4792 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4793 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4794 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4795 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
4796 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
4797 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
4798 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
4799
4800http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4801
4802 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4803 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4804 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4805 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4806 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
4807 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4808 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4809 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4810
4811http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4812 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4813
4814 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4815 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4816 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4817 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004818
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004819 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004820 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4821 http-response set-status 431
4822 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4823 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004824
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004825http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004826
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004827 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4828 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4829 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4830 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
4831 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
4832 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
4833 based on some information from the request.
4834
4835 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4836
4837http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4838
4839 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4840 inline.
4841
4842 Arguments:
4843 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4844 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4845 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4846 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4847 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4848 (request and response)
4849 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4850 processing
4851 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4852 processing
4853 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4854 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4855 and '_'.
4856
4857 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4858 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004859
4860 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004861 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004862
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004863http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004864
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004865 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4866 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4867 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4868 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4869 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4870 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4871 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4872 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4873 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4874 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4875 action.
4876 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4877 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4878 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4879 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4880 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004881
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004882http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4883http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4884http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004885
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004886 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
4887 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4888 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
4889 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
4890 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
4891 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4892
4893http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4894
4895 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
4896 about <var-name>.
4897
4898 Example:
4899 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4900
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004901
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004902http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4903 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4904
4905 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4906 yes | no | yes | yes
4907
4908 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4909 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4910 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4911 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4912 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004913 This directive allows to tune this behavior.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004914
4915 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4916
4917 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4918 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4919 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4920 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4921 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4922 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4923 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4924 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4925 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4926 not checking any request past the first one.
4927
4928 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4929 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4930 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4931 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4932 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4933 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4934 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4935
4936 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4937 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4938 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4939 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4940 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4941 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4942 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4943 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4944 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4945 downsides of rare connection failures.
4946
4947 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4948 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4949 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4950 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4951 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4952 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004953 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004954 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4955 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4956 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4957 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4958 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4959
4960 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004961 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
4962 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
4963 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004964
4965 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004966 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004967
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02004968 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
4969 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004970
4971 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4972 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4973 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4974
4975 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4976 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4977 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4978
4979 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4980
4981
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004982http-send-name-header [<header>]
4983 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4984
4985 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4986 yes | no | yes | yes
4987
4988 Arguments :
4989
4990 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4991
4992 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004993 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004994 is added with the header string proved.
4995
4996 See also : "server"
4997
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004998id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004999 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5001 no | yes | yes | yes
5002 Arguments : none
5003
5004 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5005 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5006 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005007
5008
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005009ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5010 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5011 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005012 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005013
5014 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5015 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5016 and running).
5017
5018 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5019 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5020 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005021 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005022 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5023
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005024 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5025 "unless" condition is met.
5026
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005027 Example:
5028 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5029 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5030 ignore-persist if url_static
5031
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005032 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5033
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005034load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5035 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5036 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5037 yes | no | yes | yes
5038
5039 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5040 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5041 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005042 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005043 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5044 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5045 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5046 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5047
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005048 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005049 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005050 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005051
5052 Arguments:
5053 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5054 named "server-state-file".
5055
5056 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5057 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5058 name is used as a file name.
5059
5060 none don't load any stat for this backend
5061
5062 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005063 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5064 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5065 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005066 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005067 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005068
5069 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5070 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5071
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005072 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005073
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005074 global
5075 stats socket /tmp/socket
5076 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005077
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005078 defaults
5079 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005080
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005081 backend bk
5082 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5083 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005084
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005085
5086 Then one can run :
5087
5088 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5089
5090 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5091
5092 1
5093 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5094 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5095 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5096
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005097 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005098
5099 global
5100 stats socket /tmp/socket
5101 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5102
5103 defaults
5104 load-server-state-from-file local
5105
5106 backend bk
5107 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5108 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5109
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005110
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005111 Then one can run :
5112
5113 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5114
5115 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5116
5117 1
5118 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5119 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5120 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5121
5122 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5123 "show servers state"
5124
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005125
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005126log global
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005127log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005128no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005129 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5131 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005132
5133 Prefix :
5134 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5135 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5136 prefix does not allow arguments.
5137
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005138 Arguments :
5139 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5140 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5141 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5142 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5143 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5144 parameter.
5145
5146 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5147 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5148
5149 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5150 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5151 standard syslog port).
5152
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005153 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5154 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5155 standard syslog port).
5156
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005157 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5158 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5159 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005160 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005161
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005162 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5163 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5164 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5165 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5166 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5167 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5168 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5169 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5170 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5171 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5172 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5173 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5174 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5175 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5176 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5177 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005178 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5179 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005180
5181 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5182 and "fd@2", see above.
5183
5184 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5185 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005186
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005187 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5188 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5189 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5190 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5191 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5192 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5193 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5194 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5195 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5196 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005197 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005198
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005199 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5200 one of the following :
5201
5202 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5203 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5204
5205 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5206 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5207
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005208 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5209 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5210 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5211 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5212 systemd logger consumes.
5213
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005214 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5215 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5216 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5217 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5218
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005219 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5220
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005221 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5222 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5223 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5224
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005225 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5226 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5227 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5228 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005229
5230 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5231 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5232 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005233 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5234 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5235 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5236 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5237 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005238
5239 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5240
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005241 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5242 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5243 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005244
5245 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5246 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5247 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5248 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5249
5250 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5251 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005252
5253 Example :
5254 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005255 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5256 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5257 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005258 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5259 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005260 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005261
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005262
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005263log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005264 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5265 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5266 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005267
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005268 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5269 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5270 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5271 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5272 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005273
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005274 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5275 "option httplog" directives.
5276
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005277log-format-sd <string>
5278 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5279 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5280 yes | yes | yes | no
5281
5282 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5283 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5284 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5285 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5286 which covers the log format string in depth.
5287
5288 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5289 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5290
5291 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5292 log format to "rfc5424".
5293
5294 Example :
5295 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5296
5297
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005298log-tag <string>
5299 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5300 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5301 yes | yes | yes | yes
5302
5303 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5304 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5305 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5306 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5307 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5308 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5309 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5310 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5311 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005312
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005313max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5314 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5315 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5316 yes | no | yes | yes
5317
5318 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5319 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5320 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5321 servers.
5322
5323 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5324 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5325 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5326 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5327 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005328 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005329 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5330 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5331 picking a different server.
5332
5333 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5334 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5335 even if they have to be queued.
5336
5337 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5338 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5339
5340
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005341maxconn <conns>
5342 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5344 yes | yes | yes | no
5345 Arguments :
5346 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5347 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5348 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5349 closes.
5350
5351 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5352 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5353 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5354 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005355 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5356 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5357 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5358 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005359
5360 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5361 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5362 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5363
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005364 By default, this value is set to 2000.
5365
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005366 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5367
5368
5369mode { tcp|http|health }
5370 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5372 yes | yes | yes | yes
5373 Arguments :
5374 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5375 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5376 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5377 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5378
5379 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5380 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5381 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5382 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5383 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5384
5385 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005386 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5387 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5388 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5389 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5390 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5391 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5392 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005393
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005394 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5395 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5396 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005397
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005398 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005399 defaults http_instances
5400 mode http
5401
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005402 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005403
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005404
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005405monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005406 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5408 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005409 Arguments :
5410 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5411 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005412 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005413 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5414 backend and its backup.
5415
5416 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5417 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5418 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5419 servers in a list of backends.
5420
5421 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5422 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5423 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5424 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5425 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5426 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5427 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005428 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5429 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005430
5431 Example:
5432 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005433 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005434 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5435 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5436 monitor-uri /site_alive
5437 monitor fail if site_dead
5438
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005439 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005440
5441
5442monitor-net <source>
5443 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5445 yes | yes | yes | no
5446 Arguments :
5447 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5448 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5449 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5450 followed by a mask.
5451
5452 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5453 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005454 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005455 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5456
5457 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5458 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5459 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5460 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005461 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5462 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5463 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005464
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005465 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5466 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5467 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5468 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5469 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5470 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005471
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005472 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5473 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005474
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005475 Example :
5476 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5477 frontend www
5478 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5479
5480 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5481
5482
5483monitor-uri <uri>
5484 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5486 yes | yes | yes | no
5487 Arguments :
5488 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5489 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5490
5491 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5492 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5493 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5494 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5495 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5496 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5497 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5498 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5499
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005500 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5501 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5502 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5503 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5504 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5505 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5506 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5507 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005508
5509 Example :
5510 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5511 frontend www
5512 mode http
5513 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5514
5515 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5516
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005517
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005518option abortonclose
5519no option abortonclose
5520 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5522 yes | no | yes | yes
5523 Arguments : none
5524
5525 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5526 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5527 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5528 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005529 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005530 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5531 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5532 encountered while delivering the response.
5533
5534 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5535 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5536 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5537 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5538 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5539 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005540 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005541 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005542 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005543 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5544 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5545 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5546
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005547 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5548 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005549 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5550 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5551 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5552 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5553 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5554 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005555 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005556
5557 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5558 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5559
5560 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5561
5562
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005563option accept-invalid-http-request
5564no option accept-invalid-http-request
5565 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5567 yes | yes | yes | no
5568 Arguments : none
5569
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005570 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005571 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005572 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005573 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5574 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5575 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5576 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5577 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005578 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5579 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5580 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5581 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005582 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005583 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005584 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5585 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5586 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005587
5588 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5589 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5590 been confirmed.
5591
5592 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5593 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005594 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5595 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005596 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5597
5598 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5599 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5600
5601 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5602 stats socket.
5603
5604
5605option accept-invalid-http-response
5606no option accept-invalid-http-response
5607 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5609 yes | no | yes | yes
5610 Arguments : none
5611
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005612 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005613 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005614 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005615 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5616 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5617 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5618 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5619 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005620 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5621 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5622 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005623
5624 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5625 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5626 been confirmed.
5627
5628 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5629 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5630 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5631 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5632
5633 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5634 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5635
5636 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5637 stats socket.
5638
5639
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005640option allbackups
5641no option allbackups
5642 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5644 yes | no | yes | yes
5645 Arguments : none
5646
5647 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5648 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5649 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5650 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5651 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5652 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5653 order between the backup servers anymore.
5654
5655 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5656 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5657
5658 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5659 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5660
5661
5662option checkcache
5663no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005664 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5666 yes | no | yes | yes
5667 Arguments : none
5668
5669 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5670 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005671 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005672 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5673 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005674 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005675
5676 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005677 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005678 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005679 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5680 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005681 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005682 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005683 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5684 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005685 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005686 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5687 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005688 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005689 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5690 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5691 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5692 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5693 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5694 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5695 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5696 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5697 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5698
5699 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005700 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005701 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005702 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005703 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5704
5705 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5706 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005707 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005708 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005709
5710 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5711 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5712
5713
5714option clitcpka
5715no option clitcpka
5716 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5718 yes | yes | yes | no
5719 Arguments : none
5720
5721 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5722 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005723 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005724 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5725
5726 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5727 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5728 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5729 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5730
5731 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5732 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5733 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5734 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5735 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5736
5737 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5738
5739 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5740 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5741 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5742
5743 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5744 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5745
5746 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5747
5748
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005749option contstats
5750 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5752 yes | yes | yes | no
5753 Arguments : none
5754
5755 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5756 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5757 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5758 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005759 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5760 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5761 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5762 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5763 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005764
5765
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005766option dontlog-normal
5767no option dontlog-normal
5768 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5770 yes | yes | yes | no
5771 Arguments : none
5772
5773 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5774 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5775 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5776 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5777 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5778 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5779 logged.
5780
5781 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5782 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5783 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5784
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005785 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005786 logging.
5787
5788
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005789option dontlognull
5790no option dontlognull
5791 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5793 yes | yes | yes | no
5794 Arguments : none
5795
5796 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5797 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5798 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5799 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5800 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5801 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005802 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5803 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5804 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005805
5806 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005807 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005808 would not be logged.
5809
5810 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5811 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5812
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005813 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5814 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005815
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005816
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005817option forceclose (deprecated)
5818no option forceclose (deprecated)
5819 This is an alias for "option httpclose". Thus this option is deprecated.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005820
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005821 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005822
5823
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005824option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005825 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5827 yes | yes | yes | yes
5828 Arguments :
5829 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5830 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005831 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005832 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005833
5834 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5835 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5836 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5837 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5838 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5839 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5840 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005841 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5842 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5843 possible that the client has already brought one.
5844
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005845 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005846 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005847 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005848 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005849 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005850 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005851
5852 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5853 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5854 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5855 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5856 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5857 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5858 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5859
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005860 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5861 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5862 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5863 are under the control of the end-user.
5864
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005865 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005866 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5867 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005868 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5869 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5870 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005871
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005872 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005873 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5874 frontend www
5875 mode http
5876 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5877
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005878 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5879 backend www
5880 mode http
5881 option forwardfor header X-Client
5882
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005883 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005884 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005885
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005886
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005887option http-buffer-request
5888no option http-buffer-request
5889 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5891 yes | yes | yes | yes
5892 Arguments : none
5893
5894 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5895 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5896 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5897 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5898 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5899 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5900 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5901 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005902 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005903 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5904 default.
5905
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005906 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005907
5908
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005909option http-ignore-probes
5910no option http-ignore-probes
5911 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5913 yes | yes | yes | no
5914 Arguments : none
5915
5916 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5917 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5918 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5919 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5920 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5921 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5922 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5923 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5924 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005925 was received over a connection before it was closed;
5926 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005927 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5928
5929 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5930 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5931 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5932 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5933 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5934 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5935 are often the only way to detect them.
5936
5937 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5938 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5939
5940 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5941
5942
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005943option http-keep-alive
5944no option http-keep-alive
5945 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5947 yes | yes | yes | yes
5948 Arguments : none
5949
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005950 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5951 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005952 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5953 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5954 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
5955 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
5956 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005957
5958 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5959 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005960 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5961 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5962 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5963 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5964 situations where this option may be useful :
5965
5966 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005967 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005968
5969 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5970 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5971
5972 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5973 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5974 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5975 request.
5976
5977 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5978 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005979 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5980 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5981 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005982
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005983 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5984 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5985 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5986 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5987 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5988 not set.
5989
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005990 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005991 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
5992 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005993
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005994 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005995 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005996 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005997
5998
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005999option http-no-delay
6000no option http-no-delay
6001 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6003 yes | yes | yes | yes
6004 Arguments : none
6005
6006 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6007 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6008 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6009 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6010 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6011 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6012 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6013 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6014 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6015 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6016 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6017 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6018 affected.
6019
6020 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6021 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6022 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6023 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6024 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6025 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6026 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6027 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6028 latency environments.
6029
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006030 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6031
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006032
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006033option http-pretend-keepalive
6034no option http-pretend-keepalive
6035 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006037 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006038 Arguments : none
6039
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006040 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006041 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6042 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6043 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6044 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6045 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6046 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6047 consider the response complete.
6048
6049 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6050 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6051 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6052 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006053 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006054 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6055
6056 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6057 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6058 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6059 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6060 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6061 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6062 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6063
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006064 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6065 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6066 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6067 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6068 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6069 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006070
6071 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6072 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6073
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006074 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006075 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006076
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006077
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006078option http-server-close
6079no option http-server-close
6080 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6082 yes | yes | yes | yes
6083 Arguments : none
6084
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006085 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6086 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6087 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6088 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006089 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6090 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6091 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6092 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6093 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6094 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6095 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6096 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6097 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6098 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6099 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006100
6101 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6102 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6103 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6104 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006105 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6106 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006107
6108 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6109 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006110 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6111 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6112 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006113
6114 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6115 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6116
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006117 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6118 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006119
6120
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006121option http-tunnel
6122no option http-tunnel
6123 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
6124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006125 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006126 Arguments : none
6127
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006128 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6129 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6130 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6131 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006132 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006133
6134 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006135 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006136 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6137 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6138 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6139 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6140 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6141 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6142 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006143
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006144 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6145 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6146 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6147 backend.
6148
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006149 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6150 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6151
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006152 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6153 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006154
6155
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006156option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006157no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006158 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6160 yes | yes | yes | no
6161 Arguments : none
6162
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006163 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006164 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6165 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6166 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6167 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6168 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6169 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6170
6171 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6172 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006173 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6174 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6175 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006176
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006177 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6178 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6179 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6180 front of an existing proxy.
6181
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006182 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6183
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006184 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006185
6186
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006187option http-use-htx
6188no option http-use-htx
6189 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6191 yes | yes | yes | yes
6192 Arguments : none
6193
6194 By default, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
6195 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
6196 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. Since this principle has deep
6197 roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being
6198 processed this way. It also results in the inability to establish HTTP/2
6199 connections to servers because of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1
6200 representation.
6201
6202 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6203 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6204 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6205 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
6206 most elements are directly accessed. This mechanism is still limited to the
6207 most basic operations (no compression, filters, Lua, applets, cache, etc).
6208 But it supports using either HTTP/1 or HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the
6209 other side's version.
6210
6211 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. It will cause errors to be
6212 emitted if incompatible features are used, but will allow H2 to be selected
6213 as a server protocol. It is recommended to use this option on new reasonably
6214 simple configurations, but since the feature still has incomplete functional
6215 coverage, it is not enabled by default.
6216
6217 See also : "mode http"
6218
6219
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006220option httpchk
6221option httpchk <uri>
6222option httpchk <method> <uri>
6223option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6224 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6226 yes | no | yes | yes
6227 Arguments :
6228 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6229 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6230 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6231 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6232 ones.
6233
6234 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6235 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6236 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6237
6238 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6239 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6240 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6241 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6242 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6243
6244 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6245 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6246 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6247 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6248 the lack of any response.
6249
6250 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6251
6252 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6253 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6254 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6255
6256 Examples :
6257 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6258 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6259 backend https_relay
6260 mode tcp
6261 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6262 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6263
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006264 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6265 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6266 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006267
6268
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006269option httpclose
6270no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006271 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6273 yes | yes | yes | yes
6274 Arguments : none
6275
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006276 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6277 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6278 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6279 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006280 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006281
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006282 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6283 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
6284 alos check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
6285 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6286 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006287
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006288 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6289 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6290 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006291
6292 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6293 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006294 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006295 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6296 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6297 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006298
6299 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6300 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6301
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006302 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006303
6304
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006305option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006306 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006308 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006309 Arguments :
6310 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6311 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6312 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006313 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006314 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006315
6316 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6317 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6318 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6319 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6320 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6321 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6322 ports.
6323
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006324 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6325 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006326
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006327 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6328
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006329 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006330
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006331
6332option http_proxy
6333no option http_proxy
6334 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6336 yes | yes | yes | yes
6337 Arguments : none
6338
6339 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6340 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6341 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6342 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6343 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6344
6345 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6346 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006347 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6348 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006349
6350 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6351 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6352
6353 Example :
6354 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6355 backend direct_forward
6356 option httpclose
6357 option http_proxy
6358
6359 See also : "option httpclose"
6360
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006361
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006362option independent-streams
6363no option independent-streams
6364 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6366 yes | yes | yes | yes
6367 Arguments : none
6368
6369 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6370 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6371 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6372 receive data or not.
6373
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006374 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006375 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6376 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6377 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6378 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6379 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6380 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6381 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6382 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6383 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6384 socket buffers.
6385
6386 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6387 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6388 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6389 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6390 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6391
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006392 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006393 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6394 deprecated.
6395
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006396 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006397
6398
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006399option ldap-check
6400 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6402 yes | no | yes | yes
6403 Arguments : none
6404
6405 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6406 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6407 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6408 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6409
6410 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6411 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6412
6413 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6414 configure it.
6415
6416 Example :
6417 option ldap-check
6418
6419 See also : "option httpchk"
6420
6421
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006422option external-check
6423 Use external processes for server health checks
6424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6425 yes | no | yes | yes
6426
6427 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6428 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6429 command".
6430
6431 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6432
6433 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6434
6435
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006436option log-health-checks
6437no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006438 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6440 yes | no | yes | yes
6441 Arguments : none
6442
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006443 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6444 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6445 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006446
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006447 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6448 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6449 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6450 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6451 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6452
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006453 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006454 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006455
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006456 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6457 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6458 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006459
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006460
6461option log-separate-errors
6462no option log-separate-errors
6463 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6465 yes | yes | yes | no
6466 Arguments : none
6467
6468 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6469 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6470 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6471 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6472 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6473 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6474 provides very important information.
6475
6476 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6477 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6478 error logs.
6479
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006480 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006481 logging.
6482
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006483
6484option logasap
6485no option logasap
6486 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6488 yes | yes | yes | no
6489 Arguments : none
6490
6491 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6492 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6493 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6494 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6495 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6496 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6497 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006498 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006499 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6500 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6501
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006502 Examples :
6503 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6504 mode http
6505 option httplog
6506 option logasap
6507 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6508
6509 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6510 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6511 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6512 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6513
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006514 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006515 logging.
6516
6517
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006518option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006519 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6521 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006522 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006523 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6524 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006525 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006526
6527 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6528 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006529 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006530 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6531 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6532 in the MySQL table, like this :
6533
6534 USE mysql;
6535 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6536 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6537
6538 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006539 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006540 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6541 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6542 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6543 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6544 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6545 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6546 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6547
6548 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6549 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006550
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006551 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006552
6553 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6554 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6555 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6556 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006557 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6558 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006559
6560 See also: "option httpchk"
6561
6562
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006563option nolinger
6564no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006565 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006566 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6567 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006568 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006569
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006570 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006571 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6572 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6573 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6574 connections.
6575
6576 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6577 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6578 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6579 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6580 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6581 this too.
6582
6583 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6584 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6585 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6586
6587 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6588 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6589 for servers.
6590
6591 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6592 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6593
6594
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006595option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6596 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6598 yes | yes | yes | yes
6599 Arguments :
6600 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6601 matching <network>
6602 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6603 header name.
6604
6605 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6606 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6607 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6608 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6609 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6610 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6611 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6612 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6613 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6614 possible that the client has already brought one.
6615
6616 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6617 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6618 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6619 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6620 header and requires different one.
6621
6622 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6623 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6624 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6625 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6626 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6627 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6628 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6629
6630 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6631 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6632 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6633 both are defined.
6634
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006635 Examples :
6636 # Original Destination address
6637 frontend www
6638 mode http
6639 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6640
6641 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6642 backend www
6643 mode http
6644 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6645
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006646 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006647
6648
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006649option persist
6650no option persist
6651 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6652 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6653 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006654 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006655
6656 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6657 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6658 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6659 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6660 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6661 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6662 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6663 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6664 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6665 redirected to another valid server.
6666
6667 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6668 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6669
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006670 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006671
6672
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006673option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6674 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6676 yes | no | yes | yes
6677 Arguments :
6678 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6679 PostgreSQL server.
6680
6681 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6682 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6683 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6684 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6685
6686 See also: "option httpchk"
6687
6688
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006689option prefer-last-server
6690no option prefer-last-server
6691 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6692 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6693 yes | no | yes | yes
6694 Arguments : none
6695
6696 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6697 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6698 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6699 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6700 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6701 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6702 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6703 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6704 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006705 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6706 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02006707 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
6708 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
6709 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006710 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6711 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6712 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006713
6714 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6715 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6716
6717 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6718
6719
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006720option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006721option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006722no option redispatch
6723 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6724 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6725 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006726 Arguments :
6727 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6728 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6729 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006730 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006731 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006732 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006733 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6734 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6735 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6736
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006737
6738 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6739 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6740 be able to access the service anymore.
6741
6742 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6743 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6744
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006745 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006746 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6747 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006748
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006749 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6750 "redisp" keywords.
6751
6752 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6753 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6754
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006755 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006756
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006757
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006758option redis-check
6759 Use redis health checks for server testing
6760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6761 yes | no | yes | yes
6762 Arguments : none
6763
6764 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6765 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6766 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6767 find the "+PONG" response message.
6768
6769 Example :
6770 option redis-check
6771
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006772 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006773
6774
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006775option smtpchk
6776option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6777 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6779 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006780 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006781 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02006782 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006783 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6784
6785 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6786 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6787 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6788
6789 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6790 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6791 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6792 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6793 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6794 dead server.
6795
6796 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6797 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006798 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006799 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6800
6801 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6802 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6803 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6804 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006805 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006806
6807 Example :
6808 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6809
6810 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6811
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006812
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006813option socket-stats
6814no option socket-stats
6815
6816 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6818 yes | yes | yes | no
6819
6820 Arguments : none
6821
6822
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006823option splice-auto
6824no option splice-auto
6825 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6827 yes | yes | yes | yes
6828 Arguments : none
6829
6830 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6831 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006832 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006833 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006834 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006835 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6836 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6837 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6838 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6839
6840 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6841 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6842 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6843 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6844 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6845 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6846 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6847 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6848 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6849 keyword.
6850
6851 Example :
6852 option splice-auto
6853
6854 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6855 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6856
6857 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6858 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6859
6860
6861option splice-request
6862no option splice-request
6863 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6865 yes | yes | yes | yes
6866 Arguments : none
6867
6868 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006869 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006870 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6871 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6872 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6873 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6874
6875 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6876
6877 Example :
6878 option splice-request
6879
6880 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6881 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6882
6883 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6884 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6885
6886
6887option splice-response
6888no option splice-response
6889 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6891 yes | yes | yes | yes
6892 Arguments : none
6893
6894 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006895 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006896 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6897 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6898 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6899 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6900
6901 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6902
6903 Example :
6904 option splice-response
6905
6906 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6907 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6908
6909 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6910 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6911
6912
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006913option spop-check
6914 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6916 no | no | no | yes
6917 Arguments : none
6918
6919 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6920 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6921 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6922 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6923
6924 Example :
6925 option spop-check
6926
6927 See also : "option httpchk"
6928
6929
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006930option srvtcpka
6931no option srvtcpka
6932 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6934 yes | no | yes | yes
6935 Arguments : none
6936
6937 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6938 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006939 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006940 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6941
6942 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6943 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6944 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6945 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6946
6947 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6948 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6949 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6950 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6951 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6952
6953 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6954
6955 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6956 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6957 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6958
6959 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6960 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6961
6962 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6963
6964
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006965option ssl-hello-chk
6966 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6968 yes | no | yes | yes
6969 Arguments : none
6970
6971 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6972 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6973 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6974 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6975 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6976 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6977 hello message.
6978
6979 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6980 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6981 messages, which is appreciable.
6982
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006983 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6984 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6985 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006986
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006987 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6988
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006989
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006990option tcp-check
6991 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6992 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6993 yes | no | yes | yes
6994
6995 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6996 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6997
6998 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6999 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7000 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7001
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007002 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007003 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7004 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7005 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7006 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7007 only.
7008
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007009 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007010 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7011 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7012 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7013 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7014
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007015 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007016 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7017 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007018 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007019 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7020 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7021 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7022 the respective protocols.
7023 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007024 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007025
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007026 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7027 script.
7028
7029 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7030 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7031 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7032 The "comment" is of course optional.
7033
7034
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007035 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007036 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007037 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007038 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007039
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007040 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007041 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007042 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007043
7044 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7045 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007046 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007047 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007048 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007049 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007050 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007051 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007052 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7053 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007054 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007055 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7056 tcp-check expect string +OK
7057
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007058 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007059 (send many headers before analyzing)
7060 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007061 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007062 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7063 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7064 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7065 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007066 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007067
7068
7069 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7070
7071
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007072option tcp-smart-accept
7073no option tcp-smart-accept
7074 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7076 yes | yes | yes | no
7077 Arguments : none
7078
7079 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7080 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7081 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7082 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7083 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7084 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7085
7086 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7087 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7088 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7089 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7090
7091 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7092 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7093 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007094 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007095
7096 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7097 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7098 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7099
7100 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7101 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7102 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7103
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007104 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7105
7106
7107option tcp-smart-connect
7108no option tcp-smart-connect
7109 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7111 yes | no | yes | yes
7112 Arguments : none
7113
7114 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7115 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7116 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7117 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7118 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7119
7120 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7121 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7122 complex.
7123
7124 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7125 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7126 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7127
7128 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7129 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7130
7131 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7132
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007133
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007134option tcpka
7135 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7137 yes | yes | yes | yes
7138 Arguments : none
7139
7140 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7141 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007142 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007143 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7144
7145 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7146 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7147 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7148 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7149
7150 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7151 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7152 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7153 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7154 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7155
7156 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7157
7158 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7159 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7160 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7161 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7162 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7163 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7164 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7165 backends.
7166
7167 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7168
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007169
7170option tcplog
7171 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007173 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007174 Arguments : none
7175
7176 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7177 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7178 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7179 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7180 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7181 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7182 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7183 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7184
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007185 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7186
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007187 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007188
7189
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007190option transparent
7191no option transparent
7192 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007194 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007195 Arguments : none
7196
7197 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7198 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7199 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7200 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7201 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7202 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7203 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7204 appropriate server.
7205
7206 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7207 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7208
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007209 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007210 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007211
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007212
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007213external-check command <command>
7214 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7216 yes | no | yes | yes
7217
7218 Arguments :
7219 <command> is the external command to run
7220
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007221 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7222
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007223 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007224
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007225 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7226 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7227 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7228 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7229 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7230 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007231
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007232 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7233
7234 Environment variables :
7235 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7236 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7237
7238 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7239
7240 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7241
7242 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7243 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7244 for a UNIX socket).
7245
7246 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7247
7248 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7249
7250 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7251
7252 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7253
7254 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7255
7256 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7257 socket).
7258
7259 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7260 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7261
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007262 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7263 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7264 failed.
7265
7266 Example :
7267 external-check command /bin/true
7268
7269 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7270
7271
7272external-check path <path>
7273 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7275 yes | no | yes | yes
7276
7277 Arguments :
7278 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7279
7280 The default path is "".
7281
7282 Example :
7283 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7284
7285 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7286 "external-check command"
7287
7288
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007289persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007290persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007291 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7293 yes | no | yes | yes
7294 Arguments :
7295 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007296 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7297 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007298
7299 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7300 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007301 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007302 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7303 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7304 forwarded to this server.
7305
7306 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7307 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7308 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007309 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007310 a single "listen" section.
7311
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007312 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7313 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7314 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7315
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007316 Example :
7317 listen tse-farm
7318 bind :3389
7319 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7320 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7321 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7322 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7323 persist rdp-cookie
7324 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007325 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007326 balance rdp-cookie
7327 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7328 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7329
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007330 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7331 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007332
7333
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007334rate-limit sessions <rate>
7335 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7337 yes | yes | yes | no
7338 Arguments :
7339 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7340 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7341
7342 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7343 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7344 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7345 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7346 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7347 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7348
7349 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7350 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7351 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7352 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7353
7354 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7355 listen smtp
7356 mode tcp
7357 bind :25
7358 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007359 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007360
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007361 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7362 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7363 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007364
7365 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7366
7367
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007368redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7369redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7370redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007371 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7373 no | yes | yes | yes
7374
7375 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007376 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007377
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007378 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007379 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007380 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7381 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7382 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007383
7384 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7385 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7386 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7387 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7388 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007389 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7390 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7391 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7392 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007393
7394 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7395 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7396 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7397 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7398 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7399 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007400 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007401 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007402 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7403 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7404 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007405
7406 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007407 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7408 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7409 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007410 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007411 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7412 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7413 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7414 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007415
7416 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007417 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007418
7419 - "drop-query"
7420 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7421 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7422 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7423 with a location-type redirect.
7424
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007425 - "append-slash"
7426 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7427 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7428 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7429 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7430
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007431 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7432 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7433 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7434 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7435 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7436 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7437 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7438
7439 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7440 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7441 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7442 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7443 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7444 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7445 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007446
7447 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7448 acl clear dst_port 80
7449 acl secure dst_port 8080
7450 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007451 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007452 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007453 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7454
7455 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007456 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7457 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7458 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007459 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007460
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007461 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7462 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7463 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7464
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007465 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007466 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007467
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007468 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007469 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7470 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7471 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007472
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007473 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007474
7475
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007476redisp (deprecated)
7477redispatch (deprecated)
7478 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7479 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7480 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007481 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007482
7483 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7484 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7485 be able to access the service anymore.
7486
7487 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7488 redistribute them to a working server.
7489
7490 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7491 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7492 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007493
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007494 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7495 "option redispatch" instead.
7496
7497 See also : "option redispatch"
7498
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007499
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007500reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007501 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7503 no | yes | yes | yes
7504 Arguments :
7505 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7506 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007507 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007508
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007509 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7510 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7511
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007512 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7513 the last header of an HTTP request.
7514
7515 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7516 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7517 responses.
7518
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007519 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7520 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7521 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7522
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007523 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7524 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007525
7526
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007527reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7528reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007529 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7531 no | yes | yes | yes
7532 Arguments :
7533 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7534 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7535 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7536 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7537 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7538 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7539 ignores case.
7540
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007541 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7542 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7543
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007544 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7545 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7546 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7547 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007548 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007549
7550 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7551 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7552
7553 Example :
7554 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7555 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7556 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7557
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007558 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7559 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007560
7561
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007562reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7563reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007564 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7566 no | yes | yes | yes
7567 Arguments :
7568 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7569 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7570 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7571 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7572 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7573 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7574
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007575 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7576 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7577
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007578 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7579 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7580 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7581 next servers.
7582
7583 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7584 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7585 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7586
7587 Example :
7588 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7589 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7590 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7591
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007592 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7593 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007594
7595
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007596reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7597reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007598 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7600 no | yes | yes | yes
7601 Arguments :
7602 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7603 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7604 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7605 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7606 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7607 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7608 case.
7609
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007610 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7611 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7612
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007613 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7614 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7615 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7616 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007617 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007618
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007619 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007620 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007621 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007622
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007623 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7624 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7625
7626 Example :
7627 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7628 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7629 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7630
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007631 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7632 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007633
7634
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007635reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7636reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007637 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7639 no | yes | yes | yes
7640 Arguments :
7641 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7642 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7643 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7644 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7645 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7646 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7647 case.
7648
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007649 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7650 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7651
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007652 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7653 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7654 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7655 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7656
7657 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7658 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7659
7660 Example :
7661 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7662 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7663 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7664 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7665
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007666 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7667 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007668
7669
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007670reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7671reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007672 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7674 no | yes | yes | yes
7675 Arguments :
7676 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7677 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7678 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7679 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7680 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7681 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7682
7683 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7684 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7685 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7686 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007687 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007688
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007689 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7690 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7691
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007692 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7693 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7694 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7695
7696 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7697 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7698 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7699 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7700 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7701
7702 Example :
7703 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007704 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007705 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7706 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7707
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007708 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7709 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007710
7711
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007712reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7713reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007714 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7716 no | yes | yes | yes
7717 Arguments :
7718 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7719 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7720 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7721 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7722 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7723 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7724 ignores case.
7725
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007726 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7727 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7728
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007729 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7730 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007731 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7732 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7733 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007734 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7735 not set.
7736
7737 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7738 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7739 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7740 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7741 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7742
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007743 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007744 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007745 # block all others.
7746 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7747 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7748
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007749 # block bad guys
7750 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7751 reqitarpit . if badguys
7752
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007753 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7754 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007755
7756
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007757retries <value>
7758 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7759 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7760 yes | no | yes | yes
7761 Arguments :
7762 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7763 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7764 default value is 3.
7765
7766 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7767 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7768 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7769
7770 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007771 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7772 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007773
7774 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7775 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7776
7777 See also : "option redispatch"
7778
7779
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007780rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007781 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7783 no | yes | yes | yes
7784 Arguments :
7785 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7786 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007787 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007788
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007789 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7790 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7791
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007792 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7793 the last header of an HTTP response.
7794
7795 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7796 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7797 responses.
7798
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007799 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7800 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007801
7802
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007803rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7804rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007805 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7807 no | yes | yes | yes
7808 Arguments :
7809 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7810 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7811 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7812 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7813 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7814 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7815 ignores case.
7816
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007817 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7818 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7819
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007820 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7821 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007822 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007823 client.
7824
7825 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7826 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7827 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7828
7829 Example :
7830 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007831 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007832
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007833 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7834 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007835
7836
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007837rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7838rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007839 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7841 no | yes | yes | yes
7842 Arguments :
7843 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7844 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7845 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7846 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7847 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7848 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7849 ignores case.
7850
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007851 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7852 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7853
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007854 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7855 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7856 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7857 case-sensitive.
7858
7859 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007860 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7861 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7862 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007863
7864 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7865 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7866
7867 Example :
7868 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7869 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7870
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007871 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7872 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007873
7874
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007875rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7876rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007877 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7879 no | yes | yes | yes
7880 Arguments :
7881 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7882 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7883 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7884 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7885 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7886 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7887 ignores case.
7888
7889 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7890 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7891 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7892 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007893 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007894
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007895 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7896 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7897
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007898 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7899 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7900 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7901
7902 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7903 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7904 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7905 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7906 are not case-sensitive.
7907
7908 Example :
7909 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7910 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7911
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007912 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7913 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007914
7915
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007916server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007917 Declare a server in a backend
7918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7919 no | no | yes | yes
7920 Arguments :
7921 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007922 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007923 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007924
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007925 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7926 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7927 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7928 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007929 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7930 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7931 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7932 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7933 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007934 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7935 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7936 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7937 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7938 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7939 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7940 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007941 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02007942 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
7943 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
7944 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
7945 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
7946 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
7947 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007948 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7949 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007950 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7951 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007952
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007953 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007954 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7955 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7956 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7957 adding this value to the client's port.
7958
7959 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7960 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007961 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007962
7963 Examples :
7964 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7965 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007966 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007967 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7968 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7969 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007970
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007971 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7972 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7973 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7974 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7975 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7976
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007977 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7978 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007979
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007980server-state-file-name [<file>]
7981 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7982 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7983 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7984 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7985 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7986 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7987
7988 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7989 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7990
7991 global
7992 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7993
7994 backend bk
7995 load-server-state-from-file
7996
7997 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7998 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007999
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008000server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8001 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8002 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8004 no | no | yes | yes
8005
8006 Arguments:
8007 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8008
8009 <num | range>
8010 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8011 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8012 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8013 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8014
8015 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8016
8017 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8018
8019 <params*>
8020 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8021 keyword.
8022
8023 Examples:
8024 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8025 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8026 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8027
8028 # or
8029 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8030
8031 # would be equivalent to:
8032 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8033 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8034 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8035
8036
8037
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008038source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008039source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008040source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008041 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8042 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8043 yes | no | yes | yes
8044 Arguments :
8045 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8046 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008047
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008048 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008049 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8050 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8051 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8052 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8053 supported prefixes are :
8054 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8055 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8056 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008057 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008058 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8059 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008060
8061 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8062 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008063 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8064 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8065 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008066
8067 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8068 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8069 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8070 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8071 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8072 <addr>.
8073
8074 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8075 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8076 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8077 port.
8078
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008079 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8080 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8081 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8082 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008083 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008084 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8085 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8086 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8087 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8088 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8089 HTTP header.
8090
8091 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8092 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008093 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008094 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8095 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8096 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8097 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8098 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8099 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8100 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8101
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008102 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8103 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8104 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8105 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8106 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8107 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8108
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008109 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8110 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8111 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8112 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8113
8114 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8115 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8116 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8117 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8118 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8119 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8120
8121 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8122 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8123 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8124 there are two methods :
8125
8126 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8127 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8128 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8129 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8130 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8131 of the client ranges may be used.
8132
8133 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8134 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8135 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8136 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8137 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8138 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8139 same session.
8140
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008141 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8142 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8143 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008144 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008145
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008146 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8147
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008148 Examples :
8149 backend private
8150 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8151 source 192.168.1.200
8152
8153 backend transparent_ssl1
8154 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8155 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8156
8157 backend transparent_ssl2
8158 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8159 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8160 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8161
8162 backend transparent_ssl3
8163 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8164 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8165 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8166
8167 backend transparent_smtp
8168 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8169 # with Tproxy version 4.
8170 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8171
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008172 backend transparent_http
8173 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8174 # proxy.
8175 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8176
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008177 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008178 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8179
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008180
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008181srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8182 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8184 yes | no | yes | yes
8185 Arguments :
8186 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8187 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8188 as explained at the top of this document.
8189
8190 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8191 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8192 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8193 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8194 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8195 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8196 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8197
8198 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8199 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8200 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8201 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8202 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008203 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008204 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008205 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008206
8207 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8208 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8209 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8210 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8211 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8212 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8213
8214 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8215 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8216
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008217 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8218 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008219
8220
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008221stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8222 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008224 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008225
8226 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8227 matched.
8228
8229 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8230 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8231
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008232 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8233 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008234 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008235
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008236 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8237 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8238 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8239 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008240
8241 Example :
8242 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8243 backend stats_localhost
8244 stats enable
8245 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8246
8247 Example :
8248 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8249 backend stats_auth
8250 stats enable
8251 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8252 stats admin if TRUE
8253
8254 Example :
8255 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8256 userlist stats-auth
8257 group admin users admin
8258 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8259 group readonly users haproxy
8260 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8261
8262 backend stats_auth
8263 stats enable
8264 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8265 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8266 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8267 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8268
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008269 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8270 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8271 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008272
8273
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008274stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8275 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008277 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008278 Arguments :
8279 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8280
8281 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8282
8283 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8284 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8285 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8286 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8287 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8288 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8289
8290 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8291 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8292 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008293 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008294
8295 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8296 report using "stats scope".
8297
8298 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8299 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8300 unobvious parameters.
8301
8302 Example :
8303 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8304 backend public_www
8305 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8306 stats enable
8307 stats hide-version
8308 stats scope .
8309 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008310 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008311 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8312 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8313
8314 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8315 backend private_monitoring
8316 stats enable
8317 stats uri /admin?stats
8318 stats refresh 5s
8319
8320 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8321
8322
8323stats enable
8324 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008326 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008327 Arguments : none
8328
8329 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8330 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8331 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8332 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8333 - stats auth : no authentication
8334 - stats scope : no restriction
8335
8336 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8337 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8338 unobvious parameters.
8339
8340 Example :
8341 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8342 backend public_www
8343 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8344 stats enable
8345 stats hide-version
8346 stats scope .
8347 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008348 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008349 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8350 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8351
8352 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8353 backend private_monitoring
8354 stats enable
8355 stats uri /admin?stats
8356 stats refresh 5s
8357
8358 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8359
8360
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008361stats hide-version
8362 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008364 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008365 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008366
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008367 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8368 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8369 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8370 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8371 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8372 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008373
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008374 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8375 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8376 unobvious parameters.
8377
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008378 Example :
8379 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8380 backend public_www
8381 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008382 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008383 stats hide-version
8384 stats scope .
8385 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008386 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008387 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8388 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008389
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008390 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8391 backend private_monitoring
8392 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008393 stats uri /admin?stats
8394 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008395
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008396 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008397
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008398
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008399stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8400 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8401 Access control for statistics
8402
8403 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8404 no | no | yes | yes
8405
8406 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8407 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8408 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8409 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8410 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8411 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8412
8413 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8414 instance.
8415
8416 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8417 about ACL usage.
8418
8419
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008420stats realm <realm>
8421 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008423 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008424 Arguments :
8425 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8426 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8427 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8428
8429 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8430 using a backslash ('\').
8431
8432 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8433 only related to authentication.
8434
8435 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8436 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8437 unobvious parameters.
8438
8439 Example :
8440 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8441 backend public_www
8442 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8443 stats enable
8444 stats hide-version
8445 stats scope .
8446 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008447 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008448 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8449 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8450
8451 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8452 backend private_monitoring
8453 stats enable
8454 stats uri /admin?stats
8455 stats refresh 5s
8456
8457 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8458
8459
8460stats refresh <delay>
8461 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008463 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008464 Arguments :
8465 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8466 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8467 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8468 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8469 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8470 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8471
8472 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8473 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8474 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8475 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8476
8477 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8478 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8479 unobvious parameters.
8480
8481 Example :
8482 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8483 backend public_www
8484 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8485 stats enable
8486 stats hide-version
8487 stats scope .
8488 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008489 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008490 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8491 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8492
8493 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8494 backend private_monitoring
8495 stats enable
8496 stats uri /admin?stats
8497 stats refresh 5s
8498
8499 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8500
8501
8502stats scope { <name> | "." }
8503 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008505 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008506 Arguments :
8507 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8508 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8509 section in which the statement appears.
8510
8511 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8512 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8513 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8514 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8515 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8516 exists.
8517
8518 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8519 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8520 unobvious parameters.
8521
8522 Example :
8523 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8524 backend public_www
8525 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8526 stats enable
8527 stats hide-version
8528 stats scope .
8529 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008530 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008531 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8532 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8533
8534 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8535 backend private_monitoring
8536 stats enable
8537 stats uri /admin?stats
8538 stats refresh 5s
8539
8540 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8541
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008542
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008543stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008544 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008546 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008547
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008548 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008549 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8550
8551 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8552 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8553
8554 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8555 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008556 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008557
8558 Example :
8559 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8560 backend private_monitoring
8561 stats enable
8562 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8563 stats uri /admin?stats
8564 stats refresh 5s
8565
8566 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8567 global section.
8568
8569
8570stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008571 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8573 yes | yes | yes | yes
8574 Arguments : none
8575
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008576 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008577 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8578 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8579 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8580 - IP (socket, server)
8581 - cookie (backend, server)
8582
8583 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8584 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008585 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008586
8587 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8588
8589
8590stats show-node [ <name> ]
8591 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008593 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008594 Arguments:
8595 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8596 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8597
8598 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8599 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008600 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008601
8602 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8603 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8604 unobvious parameters.
8605
8606 Example:
8607 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8608 backend private_monitoring
8609 stats enable
8610 stats show-node Europe-1
8611 stats uri /admin?stats
8612 stats refresh 5s
8613
8614 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8615 section.
8616
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008617
8618stats uri <prefix>
8619 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008621 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008622 Arguments :
8623 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8624 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8625 query string.
8626
8627 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8628 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8629 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8630 possible to reach it in the application.
8631
8632 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008633 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008634 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8635 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8636 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8637 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8638
8639 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8640 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8641 an address or a port to statistics only.
8642
8643 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8644 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8645 unobvious parameters.
8646
8647 Example :
8648 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8649 backend public_www
8650 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8651 stats enable
8652 stats hide-version
8653 stats scope .
8654 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008655 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008656 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8657 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8658
8659 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8660 backend private_monitoring
8661 stats enable
8662 stats uri /admin?stats
8663 stats refresh 5s
8664
8665 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8666
8667
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008668stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8669 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008671 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008672
8673 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008674 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008675 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008676 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008677 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8678
8679 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8680 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8681 the "stick-table" statement.
8682
8683 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8684 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8685 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8686 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8687 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8688
8689 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8690 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8691 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8692 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8693 transformation rules.
8694
8695 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8696 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8697 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8698 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8699 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8700 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8701 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8702
8703 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8704 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8705 ACL based conditions.
8706
8707 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8708 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8709 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8710 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8711
8712 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8713 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8714 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8715 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8716
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008717 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8718 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008719 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008720
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008721 Example :
8722 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8723 # last 30 minutes
8724 backend pop
8725 mode tcp
8726 balance roundrobin
8727 stick store-request src
8728 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8729 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8730 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8731
8732 backend smtp
8733 mode tcp
8734 balance roundrobin
8735 stick match src table pop
8736 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8737 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8738
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008739 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008740 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008741
8742
8743stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8744 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8746 no | no | yes | yes
8747
8748 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8749 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8750 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8751 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8752
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008753 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8754 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008755 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008756
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008757 Examples :
8758 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008759 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008760
8761 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8762 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8763 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8764
8765
8766 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8767 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8768 backend http
8769 mode http
8770 balance roundrobin
8771 stick on src table https
8772 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8773 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8774 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8775
8776 backend https
8777 mode tcp
8778 balance roundrobin
8779 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8780 stick on src
8781 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8782 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8783
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008784 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008785
8786
8787stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8788 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8790 no | no | yes | yes
8791
8792 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008793 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008794 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008795 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008796 server is selected.
8797
8798 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8799 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8800 the "stick-table" statement.
8801
8802 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8803 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8804 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8805 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8806 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8807 address.
8808
8809 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8810 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8811 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8812 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8813 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8814 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8815 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8816 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8817 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8818 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8819
8820 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8821 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8822 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8823 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8824 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8825 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8826 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8827
8828 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8829 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8830 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8831 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8832
8833 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8834 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8835 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8836 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8837 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8838 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008839 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8840 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8841 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8842 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8843 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8844 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008845
8846 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8847 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8848 the request.
8849
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008850 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8851 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008852 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008853
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008854 Example :
8855 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8856 # last 30 minutes
8857 backend pop
8858 mode tcp
8859 balance roundrobin
8860 stick store-request src
8861 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8862 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8863 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8864
8865 backend smtp
8866 mode tcp
8867 balance roundrobin
8868 stick match src table pop
8869 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8870 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8871
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008872 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008873 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008874
8875
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008876stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008877 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8878 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008879 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008881 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008882
8883 Arguments :
8884 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8885 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8886 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8887 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8888
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008889 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8890 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8891 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8892 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8893
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008894 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8895 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8896 instance.
8897
8898 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8899 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8900 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8901 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8902 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8903 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008904 to 32 characters.
8905
8906 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8907 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8908 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008909 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008910 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8911 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008912
8913 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008914 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8915 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008916 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8917 increase.
8918
8919 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008920 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8921 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8922 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008923
8924 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8925 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8926 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8927 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008928 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008929 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8930 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8931 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8932 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8933 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8934 parameter (see below).
8935
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008936 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8937 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8938 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8939 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8940 soft restart.
8941
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008942 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8943 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008944
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008945 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8946 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8947 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8948 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008949 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008950 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008951 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8952 if not expiration delay is specified.
8953
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008954 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8955 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8956 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8957 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008958 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8959 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8960 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8961 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8962 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8963 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8964 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8965 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8966 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8967 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8968 types and their arguments.
8969
8970 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8971 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8972 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8973 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8974
8975 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8976 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8977 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008978 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008979
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008980 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8981 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8982 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008983 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008984 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008985 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008986
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01008987 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8988 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8989 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8990 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
8991
8992 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
8993 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8994 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8995 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8996 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8997 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
8998
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008999 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9000 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9001 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9002 they were received.
9003
9004 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9005 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9006 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9007 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9008 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9009
9010 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9011 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9012 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9013 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9014 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9015
9016 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9017 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9018 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9019
9020 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9021 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9022 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9023 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9024 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9025
9026 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9027 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9028 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9029 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9030 the client side.
9031
9032 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9033 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9034 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9035 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9036 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9037 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9038 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9039
9040 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9041 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9042 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9043 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9044 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9045 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009046 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009047
9048 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9049 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9050 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9051 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9052 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9053 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9054
9055 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009056 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009057 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9058 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9059
9060 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9061 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9062 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9063 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9064 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9065 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9066 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9067 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9068 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9069 recommended for better fairness.
9070
9071 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009072 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009073 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9074 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9075
9076 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9077 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9078 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9079 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9080 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9081 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9082 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9083 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9084 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9085 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009086
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009087 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9088 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009089 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9090 reference it.
9091
9092 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9093 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009094 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9095 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9096 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009097
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009098 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9099 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9100 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9101 something that can be ignored.
9102
9103 Example:
9104 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9105 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9106 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9107 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9108
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009109 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009110 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009111
9112
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009113stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009114 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9116 no | no | yes | yes
9117
9118 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009119 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009120 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009121 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009122 server is selected.
9123
9124 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9125 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9126 the "stick-table" statement.
9127
9128 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9129 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9130 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9131 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9132
9133 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9134 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9135 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9136 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9137 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9138 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009139 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009140 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9141 rules.
9142
9143 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9144 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9145 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9146 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9147 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9148 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9149 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9150
9151 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9152 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9153 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9154 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9155
9156 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9157 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9158 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9159 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9160 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9161 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009162 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9163 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9164 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9165 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9166 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9167 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9168 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9169 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9170 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009171
9172 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9173
9174 Example :
9175 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9176 backend https
9177 mode tcp
9178 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009179 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009180 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009181
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009182 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9183 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9184
9185 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9186 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9187 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9188
9189 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9190 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009191
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009192 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9193 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9194 # at offset 44.
9195
9196 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9197 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9198
9199 # Learn on response if server hello.
9200 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009201
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009202 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9203 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9204
9205 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9206 extraction.
9207
9208
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009209tcp-check connect [params*]
9210 Opens a new connection
9211 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9212 no | no | yes | yes
9213
9214 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9215 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9216 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9217
9218 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9219 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9220 of the sequence.
9221
9222 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9223 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9224 do.
9225
9226 Parameters :
9227 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9228 use the TCP connection.
9229
9230 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9231 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9232 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9233
9234 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9235
9236 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9237
9238 Examples:
9239 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9240 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9241 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9242 option tcp-check
9243 tcp-check connect
9244 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9245 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9246 tcp-check send \r\n
9247 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9248 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9249 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9250 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9251 tcp-check send \r\n
9252 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9253 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9254
9255 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9256 option tcp-check
9257 tcp-check connect port 110
9258 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9259 tcp-check connect port 143
9260 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9261 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9262
9263 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9264
9265
9266tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009267 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009268 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9269 no | no | yes | yes
9270
9271 Arguments :
9272 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9273 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9274 binary.
9275 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9276 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9277 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9278
9279 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9280 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9281 with the usual backslash ('\').
9282 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009283 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009284 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9285 used upper or lower case.
9286
9287
9288 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9289
9290 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9291 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9292 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9293 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9294 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9295 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9296 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9297 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9298
9299 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9300 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9301 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9302 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9303 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9304 expression.
9305
9306 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9307 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9308 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9309 this exact hexadecimal string.
9310 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9311
9312 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9313 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9314 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9315 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9316 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9317 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9318 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9319 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9320 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9321 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9322 the null character.
9323
9324 Examples :
9325 # perform a POP check
9326 option tcp-check
9327 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9328
9329 # perform an IMAP check
9330 option tcp-check
9331 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9332
9333 # look for the redis master server
9334 option tcp-check
9335 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009336 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009337 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9338 tcp-check expect string role:master
9339 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9340 tcp-check expect string +OK
9341
9342
9343 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9344 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9345
9346
9347tcp-check send <data>
9348 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9349 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9350 no | no | yes | yes
9351
9352 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9353 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9354
9355 Examples :
9356 # look for the redis master server
9357 option tcp-check
9358 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9359 tcp-check expect string role:master
9360
9361 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9362 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9363
9364
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009365tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9366 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009367 tcp health check
9368 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9369 no | no | yes | yes
9370
9371 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9372 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009373 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009374 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9375 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9376 hexadecimal string.
9377 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9378
9379 Examples :
9380 # redis check in binary
9381 option tcp-check
9382 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9383 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9384
9385
9386 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9387 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9388
9389
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009390tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9391 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9393 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009394 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009395 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9396 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009397
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009398 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009399
9400 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9401 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009402 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9403 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9404 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9405 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9406 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9407 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009408
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009409 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9410 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9411 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9412 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009413
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009414 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009415 - accept :
9416 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9417 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9418 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009419
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009420 - reject :
9421 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9422 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9423 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9424 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9425 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9426 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9427 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9428 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9429 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9430 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9431 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009432 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009433
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009434 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9435 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9436 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9437 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9438 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9439 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9440 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9441 hosts.
9442
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009443 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9444 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9445 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9446 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9447 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9448 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9449 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9450 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9451
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009452 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9453 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9454 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9455 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9456 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9457 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9458 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9459 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9460 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009461 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9462 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009463
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009464 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009465 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009466 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9467 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9468 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
9469 haproxy -vv) whichs defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
9470 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9471 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9472 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9473 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9474 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9475 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9476 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9477 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009478
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009479 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009480 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009481 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009482 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009483 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9484 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9485 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009486
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009487 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9488 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9489 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9490 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009491
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009492 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9493 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9494 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9495 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9496 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009497 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9498 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9499 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9500 layer7 information is extracted.
9501
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009502 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9503 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9504 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9505 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9506 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009507
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009508 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9509 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9510 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9511 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9512
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009513 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9514 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9515 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9516 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9517
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009518 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9519 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9520 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9521 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9522 continues.
9523
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009524 - set-src <expr> :
9525 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9526 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9527 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009528 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009529
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009530 Arguments:
9531 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9532 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009533
9534 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009535 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9536
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009537 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9538 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009539
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009540 - set-src-port <expr> :
9541 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9542 expression.
9543
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009544 Arguments:
9545 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9546 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009547
9548 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009549 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9550
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009551 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9552 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9553 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009554
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009555 - set-dst <expr> :
9556 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9557 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9558 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9559 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9560 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9561
9562 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9563 followed by some converters.
9564
9565 Example:
9566
9567 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9568 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9569
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009570 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9571 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9572
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009573 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9574 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9575 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9576 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9577
9578
9579 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9580 followed by some converters.
9581
9582 Example:
9583
9584 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9585
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009586 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9587 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9588 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9589
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009590 - "silent-drop" :
9591 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009592 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009593 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9594 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9595 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9596 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9597 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009598 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9599 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009600 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9601 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009602 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009603 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9604 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9605 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9606 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9607
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009608 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9609 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9610 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009611
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009612 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9613 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9614 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009615
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009616 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009617 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009618 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009619
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009620 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9621 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9622 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009623
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009624 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009625 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9626 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009627
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009628 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9629
9630 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9631
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009632 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9633
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009634 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009635
9636
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009637tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9638 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009640 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009641 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009642 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9643 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009644
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009645 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009646
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009647 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009648 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9649 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9650 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9651 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009652
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009653 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9654 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9655 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9656 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009657 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9658 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9659 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9660 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9661 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9662 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009663 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009664 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009665
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009666 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9667 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9668 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9669 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009670
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009671 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009672 - accept : the request is accepted
9673 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9674 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009675 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009676 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009677 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009678 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009679 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009680 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009681 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009682 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009683 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009684
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009685 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9686 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009687
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009688 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9689 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9690 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9691 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9692 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9693 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009694
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009695 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009696 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9697 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009698
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009699 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009700 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9701 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9702 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9703 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009704 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9705 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9706 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009707
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009708 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009709 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9710 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9711 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009712
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009713 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009714 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9715 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009716
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009717 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9718 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009719 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009720 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9721 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009722 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009723 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009724 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009725 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9726 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009727 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009728 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9729 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009730
9731 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9732 followed by some converters.
9733
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009734 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9735 <var-name>.
9736
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009737 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9738 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9739 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9740 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9741 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9742
9743 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9744 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9745 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9746 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9747 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9748 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9749 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9750 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9751 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9752 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9753 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9754
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009755 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9756 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9757 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9758 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9759 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9760
9761 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9762
9763 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9764
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009765 Example:
9766
9767 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009768 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009769
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009770 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009771 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9772 # and reject everything else.
9773 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9774 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009775 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009776 tcp-request content reject
9777
9778 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009779 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9780 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9781 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009782 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009783
9784 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9785 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9786 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009787 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009788 tcp-request content reject
9789
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009790 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009791 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009792 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009793 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009794 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9795 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009796
9797 Example:
9798 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9799 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009800 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009801
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009802 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009803 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009804
9805 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009806 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009807 # protecting all our sites
9808 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009809 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9810 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009811 ...
9812 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9813
9814 backend http_dynamic
9815 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009816 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009817 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009818 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009819 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009820 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009821 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009822
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009823 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009824
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009825 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9826 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009827
9828
9829tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9830 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009832 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009833 Arguments :
9834 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9835 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9836 as explained at the top of this document.
9837
9838 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9839 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9840 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9841 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9842 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9843
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009844 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9845 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9846 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9847 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9848
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009849 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9850 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009851 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009852 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009853 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9854 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9855 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9856 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009857
9858 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9859 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9860 it pass through unaffected.
9861
9862 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9863 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9864 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009865 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009866 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9867 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009868 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9869 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9870 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009871
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009872 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009873 "timeout client".
9874
9875
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009876tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9877 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9879 no | no | yes | yes
9880 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009881 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9882 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009883
9884 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9885
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009886 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009887 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9888 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009889 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9890 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009891
9892 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9893
9894 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9895 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9896 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9897 inserted.
9898
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009899 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009900 - accept :
9901 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9902 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9903 the rules evaluation.
9904
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009905 - close :
9906 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9907 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9908 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9909 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9910 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9911 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009912 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009913 protocols.
9914
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009915 - reject :
9916 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9917 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009918 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009919
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009920 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9921 Sets a variable.
9922
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009923 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9924 Unsets a variable.
9925
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009926 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9927 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9928 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9929 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9930
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009931 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9932 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9933 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9934 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9935
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009936 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9937 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9938 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9939 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9940 continues.
9941
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009942 - "silent-drop" :
9943 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009944 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009945 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9946 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9947 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9948 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9949 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009950 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9951 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009952 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9953 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009954 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009955 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9956 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9957 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9958 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9959
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009960 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
9961 Send a group of SPOE messages.
9962
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009963 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9964 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9965 for changing the default action to a reject.
9966
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009967 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9968 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9969 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9970 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009971 period.
9972
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009973 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9974 declared inline.
9975
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009976 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9977 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009978 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009979 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9980 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009981 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009982 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009983 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009984 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9985 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009986 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009987 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9988 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009989
9990 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9991 followed by some converters.
9992
9993 Example:
9994
9995 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9996
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009997 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9998 <var-name>.
9999
10000 Example:
10001
10002 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10003
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010004 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10005 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10006 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10007 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10008 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10009
10010 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10011
10012 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10013
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010014 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10015
10016 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10017
10018
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010019tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10020 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10022 no | yes | yes | no
10023 Arguments :
10024 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10025 below.
10026
10027 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10028
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010029 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010030 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10031 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10032 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10033 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10034 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10035 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10036 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010037 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010038 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10039 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10040 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10041 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10042 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10043 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10044 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10045 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10046 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10047 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10048 instead.
10049
10050 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10051 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10052 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10053 rules which may be inserted.
10054
10055 Several types of actions are supported :
10056 - accept : the request is accepted
10057 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10058 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10059 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010060 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010061 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10062 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010063 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010064 - silent-drop
10065
10066 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10067 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10068 sections for a complete description.
10069
10070 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10071 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10072 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10073
10074 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10075 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10076 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10077 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10078 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10079
10080 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10081 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10082
10083 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10084 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10085 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10086
10087 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10088 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10089 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10090
10091 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10092 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10093 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10094
10095 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10096 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10097 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10098
10099 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10100
10101 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10102
10103
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010104tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10105 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10107 no | no | yes | yes
10108 Arguments :
10109 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10110 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10111 as explained at the top of this document.
10112
10113 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10114
10115
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010116timeout check <timeout>
10117 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10118 established.
10119
10120 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10121 yes | no | yes | yes
10122 Arguments:
10123 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10124 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10125 as explained at the top of this document.
10126
10127 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10128 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010129 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010130 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010131 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10132 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10133 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010134
10135 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10136 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10137
10138 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10139 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010140 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010141
10142 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10143 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10144 forget about it.
10145
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010146 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10147 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010148
10149
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010150timeout client <timeout>
10151timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10152 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10154 yes | yes | yes | no
10155 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010156 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010157 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10158 as explained at the top of this document.
10159
10160 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10161 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10162 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010163 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10164 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10165 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10166 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010167 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10168 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10169 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010170 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010171 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010172 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10173 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010174 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10175 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010176
10177 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10178 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10179 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10180 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10181 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10182 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10183
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010184 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010185
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010186 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10187 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10188 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10189
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010190 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10191 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010192
10193
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010194timeout client-fin <timeout>
10195 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10197 yes | yes | yes | no
10198 Arguments :
10199 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10200 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10201 as explained at the top of this document.
10202
10203 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10204 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10205 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10206 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10207 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10208 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10209 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010210 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10211 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10212 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010213
10214 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10215 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10216 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10217
10218 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10219
10220
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010221timeout connect <timeout>
10222timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10223 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10225 yes | no | yes | yes
10226 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010227 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010228 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10229 as explained at the top of this document.
10230
10231 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010232 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010233 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010234 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010235 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10236 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010237
10238 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10239 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10240 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10241 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10242 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
10243 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10244
10245 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10246 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10247 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10248
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010249 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10250 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010251
10252
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010253timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10254 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10256 yes | yes | yes | yes
10257 Arguments :
10258 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10259 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10260 as explained at the top of this document.
10261
10262 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10263 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10264 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10265 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10266 once the request has started to present itself.
10267
10268 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10269 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10270 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10271 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10272 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10273
10274 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10275 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10276 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10277 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10278
10279 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10280 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010281 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010282 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10283 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010284 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010285
10286 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10287 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10288 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10289 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10290
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010291 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10292 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010293 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10294
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010295 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10296
10297
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010298timeout http-request <timeout>
10299 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010301 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010302 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010303 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010304 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10305 as explained at the top of this document.
10306
10307 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10308 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10309 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10310 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10311 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10312 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10313 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010314 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10315 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10316 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10317 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010318 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010319 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10320 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010321
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010322 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10323 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10324 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10325 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10326 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010327 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010328
10329 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10330 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010331 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010332 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10333 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10334
10335 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010336 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10337 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10338 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010339
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010340 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010341 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010342
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010343
10344timeout queue <timeout>
10345 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10347 yes | no | yes | yes
10348 Arguments :
10349 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10350 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10351 as explained at the top of this document.
10352
10353 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10354 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10355 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10356 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10357 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10358
10359 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10360 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10361 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10362 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10363
10364 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10365
10366
10367timeout server <timeout>
10368timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10369 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10371 yes | no | yes | yes
10372 Arguments :
10373 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10374 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10375 as explained at the top of this document.
10376
10377 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10378 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10379 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10380 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10381 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10382 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10383 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10384
10385 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10386 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10387 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10388 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10389 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010390 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010391 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010392 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10393 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010394 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10395 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010396
10397 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10398 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10399 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10400 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10401 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10402 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10403
10404 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10405 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10406 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10407
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010408 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010409
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010410
10411timeout server-fin <timeout>
10412 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10414 yes | no | yes | yes
10415 Arguments :
10416 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10417 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10418 as explained at the top of this document.
10419
10420 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10421 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10422 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10423 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10424 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10425 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10426 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10427 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10428 situations, it should not be needed.
10429
10430 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10431 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10432 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10433
10434 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10435
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010436
10437timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010438 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10440 yes | yes | yes | yes
10441 Arguments :
10442 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10443 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10444 as explained at the top of this document.
10445
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010446 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10447 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10448 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10449 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010450
10451 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10452 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10453 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10454 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010455 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010456
10457 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10458
10459
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010460timeout tunnel <timeout>
10461 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10463 yes | no | yes | yes
10464 Arguments :
10465 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10466 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10467 as explained at the top of this document.
10468
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010469 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010470 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10471 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10472 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010473 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10474 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010475 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10476 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10477 specified.
10478
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010479 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10480 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10481 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10482 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10483 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10484 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10485 state.
10486
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010487 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10488 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10489 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10490 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010491 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010492
10493 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10494 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10495 forget about it.
10496
10497 Example :
10498 defaults http
10499 option http-server-close
10500 timeout connect 5s
10501 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010502 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010503 timeout server 30s
10504 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10505
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010506 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010507
10508
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010509transparent (deprecated)
10510 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010512 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010513 Arguments : none
10514
10515 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10516 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10517 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10518 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10519 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10520 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10521 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10522 appropriate server.
10523
10524 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10525
10526 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10527 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10528
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010529 See also: "option transparent"
10530
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010531unique-id-format <string>
10532 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10534 yes | yes | yes | no
10535 Arguments :
10536 <string> is a log-format string.
10537
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010538 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10539 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10540 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10541 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010542
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010543 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10544 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10545 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10546 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10547 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10548 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10549 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10550 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010551
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010552 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10553 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010554
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010555 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010556
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010557 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010558
10559 will generate:
10560
10561 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10562
10563 See also: "unique-id-header"
10564
10565unique-id-header <name>
10566 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10568 yes | yes | yes | no
10569 Arguments :
10570 <name> is the name of the header.
10571
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010572 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10573 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010574
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010575 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010576
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010577 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010578 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10579
10580 will generate:
10581
10582 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10583
10584 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010585
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010586use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010587 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10589 no | yes | yes | no
10590 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010591 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10592 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010593
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010594 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10595 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010596
10597 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10598 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10599 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010600 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010601 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010602 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10603 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010604
10605 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10606 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10607 assign the backend.
10608
10609 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10610 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10611 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10612 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10613 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10614 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10615
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010616 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010617 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010618 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10619 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10620 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10621
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010622 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10623 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10624 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10625 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10626 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10627 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10628 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10629 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10630 cannot be forced from the request.
10631
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010632 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010633 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10634 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10635
10636 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10637 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010638
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010639
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010640use-server <server> if <condition>
10641use-server <server> unless <condition>
10642 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10644 no | no | yes | yes
10645 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010646 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010647
10648 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10649
10650 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10651 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10652 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10653
10654 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10655 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10656 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10657 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10658 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10659 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10660 matches will assign the server.
10661
10662 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10663 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10664 with the next rules until one matches.
10665
10666 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10667 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10668 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10669 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10670
10671 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10672 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10673 stripped.
10674
10675 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10676 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10677 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10678 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10679
10680 Example :
10681 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10682 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10683 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10684 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10685 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10686 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010687 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010688 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10689 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10690
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010691 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010692
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010693
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100106945. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010695--------------------------
10696
10697The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10698depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10699settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10700written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10701described in this section.
10702
10703
107045.1. Bind options
10705-----------------
10706
10707The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10708as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10709no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10710parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10711while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10712provided immediately after the setting name.
10713
10714The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10715
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010716accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10717 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10718 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10719 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10720 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10721 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10722 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10723 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10724 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10725 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010726 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10727 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10728 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010729
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010730accept-proxy
10731 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010732 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10733 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010734 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10735 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10736 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10737 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010738 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010739 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10740 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010741 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10742 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010743
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010744allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010745 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010746 due to security considerations.
10747
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010748alpn <protocols>
10749 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10750 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10751 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10752 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10753 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010754 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10755 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10756 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10757 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10758 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10759 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10760 preference, like below :
10761
10762 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010763
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010764backlog <backlog>
10765 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10766 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10767
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010768curves <curves>
10769 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10770 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10771 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10772 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10773 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10774 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10775
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010776ecdhe <named curve>
10777 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010778 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10779 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010780
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010781ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010782 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10783 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10784 client's certificate.
10785
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010786ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10787 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10788 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10789 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10790 error is ignored.
10791
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010792ca-sign-file <cafile>
10793 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10794 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10795 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10796 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10797 'generate-certificates' for details.
10798
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010799ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010800 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10801 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10802 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10803 'generate-certificates' for details.
10804
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010805ciphers <ciphers>
10806 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10807 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010808 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake except for TLSv1.3. The format of the
10809 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for
10810 instance a string such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without
10811 quotes). Depending on the compatibility and security requirements, the list
10812 of suitable ciphers depends on a variety of variables. For background
10813 information and recommendations see e.g.
10814 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10815 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10816 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10817
10818ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10819 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10820 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10821 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10822 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
10823 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section, and can be for instance a
10824 string such as
10825 "TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256"
10826 (without quotes). For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check
10827 the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010828
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010829crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010830 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10831 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10832 to verify client's certificate.
10833
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010834crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010835 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10836 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10837 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10838 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10839 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10840 file.
10841
10842 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10843 are loaded.
10844
10845 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010846 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010847 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10848 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10849 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10850 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010851 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10852 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010853 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010854
10855 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10856 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10857 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10858 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010859 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10860 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010861
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010862 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010863
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010864 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010865 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010866 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10867 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010868 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10869 clients).
10870
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010871 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10872 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10873 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10874 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10875 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10876 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10877 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10878 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10879 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10880 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10881 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10882 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10883 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10884
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010885 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10886 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10887 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10888 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10889 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10890
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010891 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10892 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10893 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10894 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010895
10896 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10897 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10898 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10899 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10900 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10901 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10902 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10903 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10904 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10905
10906 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10907
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010908 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010909 a cert bundle.
10910
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010911 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010912 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10913 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10914 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10915 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10916 provide multi-cert support.
10917
10918 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10919
10920 Filename | CN | SAN
10921 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10922 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010923 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010924 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10925 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10926
10927 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10928 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10929 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10930 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010931 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10932 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10933 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010934
10935 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10936 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10937
10938 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10939 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10940 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10941
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010942crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010943 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010944 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010945 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010946 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010947
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010948crt-list <file>
10949 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010950 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10951 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010952
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010953 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10954
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010955 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10956 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010957 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010958 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010959
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010960 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10961 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10962 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10963 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10964 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10965 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10966 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10967 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010968
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010969 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010970 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010971 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
10972 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
10973 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010974
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010975 crt-list file example:
10976 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010977 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010978 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010979 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010980
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010981defer-accept
10982 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10983 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10984 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010985 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010986 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10987 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10988 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10989 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10990 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10991 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10992 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10993
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010994expose-fd listeners
10995 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
10996 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020010997 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
10998 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010999 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011000
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011001force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011002 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011003 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011004 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011005 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011006
11007force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011008 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011009 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011010 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011011
11012force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011013 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011014 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011015 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011016
11017force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011018 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011019 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011020 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011021
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011022force-tlsv13
11023 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11024 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011025 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011026
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011027generate-certificates
11028 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11029 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11030 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11031 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11032 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11033 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11034 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11035 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11036 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11037 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11038 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11039
11040 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11041 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011042 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011043 certificate is used many times.
11044
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011045gid <gid>
11046 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11047 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11048 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11049 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11050 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11051
11052group <group>
11053 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11054 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11055 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11056 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11057 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11058
11059id <id>
11060 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11061 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11062 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11063 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11064
11065interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011066 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11067 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11068 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11069 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11070 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11071 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011072 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11073 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11074 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11075 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11076 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11077 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011078
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011079level <level>
11080 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11081 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11082 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011083 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011084 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11085 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11086 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011087 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011088 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011089 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011090 all counters).
11091
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011092severity-output <format>
11093 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11094 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11095 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11096 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11097 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11098 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11099 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11100 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11101 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11102 rfc5424 convention.
11103
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011104maxconn <maxconn>
11105 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11106 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11107 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11108 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11109 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11110 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11111 eat all memory.
11112
11113mode <mode>
11114 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11115 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11116 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11117 UNIX sockets.
11118
11119mss <maxseg>
11120 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11121 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11122 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11123 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11124 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11125 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11126 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11127 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11128 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11129 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11130 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11131
11132name <name>
11133 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11134 page.
11135
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011136namespace <name>
11137 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11138 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11139 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11140 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11141
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011142nice <nice>
11143 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11144 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11145 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11146 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11147 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11148 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11149 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11150 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11151 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11152 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11153 one for an RDP socket.
11154
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011155no-ca-names
11156 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11157 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11158
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011159no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011160 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011161 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011162 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011163 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011164 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11165 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011166
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011167no-tls-tickets
11168 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11169 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11170 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011171 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11172 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011173
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011174no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011175 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011176 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011177 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011178 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011179 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11180 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011181
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011182no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011183 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011184 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011185 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011186 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011187 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11188 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011189
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011190no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011191 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011192 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011193 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011194 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011195 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11196 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011197
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011198no-tlsv13
11199 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11200 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11201 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11202 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011203 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11204 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011205
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011206npn <protocols>
11207 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11208 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11209 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11210 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011211 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011212 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11213 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11214 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11215 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11216 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011217
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011218prefer-client-ciphers
11219 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11220 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11221 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011222 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11223 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11224 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011225
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011226process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
11227 This restricts the list of processes and/or threads on which this listener is
11228 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011229 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011230 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11231 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11232 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11233 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011234 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011235 connections for this listener, for the corresponding process set. For the
11236 unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
11237 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
11238
11239 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11240
11241 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11242 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11243 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11244 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11245 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11246 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11247 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11248 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011249
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011250proto <name>
11251 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11252 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11253 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11254 in haproxy -vv.
11255 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11256 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011257 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011258 h2" on the bind line.
11259
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011260ssl
11261 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011262 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011263 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11264 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011265 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11266 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011267
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011268ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11269 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11270 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11271 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11272
11273ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11274 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11275 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11276 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11277
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011278strict-sni
11279 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11280 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11281 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11282 See the "crt" option for more information.
11283
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011284tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011285 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011286 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11287 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011288 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011289 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11290 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11291 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11292 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11293 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11294 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11295 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11296
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011297tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011298 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011299 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11300 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11301 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11302 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11303 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11304 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11305 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011306 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11307 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11308 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011309
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011310tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11311 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
11312 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
11313 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
11314 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
11315 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
11316 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
11317 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
11318 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
11319 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11320 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11321
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011322transparent
11323 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11324 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11325 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11326 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11327 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11328 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11329 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11330 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11331 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11332 so check for support with your vendor.
11333
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011334v4v6
11335 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11336 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11337 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11338 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011339 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011340
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011341v6only
11342 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11343 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11344 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011345 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11346 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011347
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011348uid <uid>
11349 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11350 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11351 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11352 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11353 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11354
11355user <user>
11356 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11357 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11358 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11359 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11360 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11361
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011362verify [none|optional|required]
11363 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11364 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11365 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11366 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11367 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011368 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11369 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11370 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11371 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011372
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200113735.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011374------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011375
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011376The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11377which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11378arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11379settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11380after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11381Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11382address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011383
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011384 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011385 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011386
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011387Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11388keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11389
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011390The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011391
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011392addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011393 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011394 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11395 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11396 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11397 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11398 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011399
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011400agent-check
11401 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011402 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
11403 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
11404 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
11405 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011406
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011407 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011408 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011409 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11410 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11411 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011412
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011413 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11414 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11415 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11416 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11417 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011418
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011419 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011420 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011421
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011422 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11423 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11424 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011425
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011426 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11427 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11428 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011429
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011430 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11431 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11432 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11433 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11434 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011435 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011436 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011437
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011438 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11439 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011440
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011441 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11442 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11443 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11444 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11445 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11446 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11447 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11448 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11449 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011450
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011451 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11452 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011453 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11454 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11455 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011456 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011457
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011458 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011459 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011460
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011461agent-send <string>
11462 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11463 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11464 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11465 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11466 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11467
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011468agent-inter <delay>
11469 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11470 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11471
11472 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11473 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11474 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11475 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11476 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11477 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11478 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11479 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11480 of backends use the same servers.
11481
11482 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11483
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011484agent-addr <addr>
11485 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11486
11487 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11488 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11489 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11490 hostname, it will be resolved.
11491
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011492agent-port <port>
11493 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11494
11495 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11496
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011497backup
11498 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11499 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11500 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11501 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011502 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11503 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011504
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011505ca-file <cafile>
11506 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11507 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11508 server's certificate.
11509
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011510check
11511 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011512 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11513 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11514 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11515 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11516 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11517 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11518 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011519 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11520 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011521 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11522 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011523
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011524check-send-proxy
11525 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11526 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11527 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11528 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11529 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11530 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11531 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11532
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011533check-sni
11534 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
11535 over SSL.
11536
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011537check-ssl
11538 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11539 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11540 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11541 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011542 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011543 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11544 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011545 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011546 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11547 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011548
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011549ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011550 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11551 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11552 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011553 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
11554 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
11555 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
11556 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
11557 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
11558 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
11559
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011560ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11561 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11562 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11563 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11564 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
11565 "man 1 ciphers" under the "ciphersuites" section.
11566
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011567cookie <value>
11568 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11569 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11570 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11571 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11572 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11573 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11574 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11575
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011576crl-file <crlfile>
11577 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11578 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11579 to verify server's certificate.
11580
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011581crt <cert>
11582 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11583 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11584 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11585 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11586 certificate request.
11587
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011588disabled
11589 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11590 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11591 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11592 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11593 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011594 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011595
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011596enabled
11597 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11598 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11599 default value.
11600 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11601 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011602
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011603error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011604 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11605 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11606 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011607
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011608 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011609
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011610fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011611 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11612 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11613 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11614
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011615force-sslv3
11616 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11617 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011618 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011619 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011620
11621force-tlsv10
11622 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011623 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011624 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011625
11626force-tlsv11
11627 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011628 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011629 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011630
11631force-tlsv12
11632 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011633 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011634 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011635
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011636force-tlsv13
11637 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11638 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011639 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011640
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011641id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011642 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11643 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11644 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011645
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011646init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11647 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11648 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011649 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011650 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11651 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11652 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11653 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11654 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11655 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11656 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11657 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11658 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011659 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011660 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11661 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11662 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11663 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11664 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11665 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011666 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011667
11668 Example:
11669 defaults
11670 # never fail on address resolution
11671 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11672
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011673inter <delay>
11674fastinter <delay>
11675downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011676 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11677 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11678 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11679 between checks depending on the server state :
11680
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011681 Server state | Interval used
11682 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11683 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11684 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11685 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11686 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11687 or yet unchecked. |
11688 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11689 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11690 | "inter" otherwise.
11691 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011692
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011693 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11694 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11695 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11696 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011697 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11698 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11699 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11700 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11701 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011702
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011703maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011704 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11705 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11706 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11707 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11708 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11709 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11710 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11711 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11712
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011713maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011714 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11715 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11716 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11717 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11718 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11719 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11720 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11721
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011722minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011723 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11724 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11725 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11726 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11727 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11728 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011729 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011730 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011731
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011732namespace <name>
11733 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11734 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11735 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11736 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11737
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011738no-agent-check
11739 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11740 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11741 default value.
11742 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11743 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11744
11745no-backup
11746 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11747 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11748 default value.
11749 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11750 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11751
11752no-check
11753 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11754 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11755 default value.
11756 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11757 "default-server" "check" setting.
11758
11759no-check-ssl
11760 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11761 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11762 default value.
11763 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11764 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11765
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011766no-send-proxy
11767 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11768 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11769 default value.
11770 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11771 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11772
11773no-send-proxy-v2
11774 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11775 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11776 default value.
11777 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11778 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11779
11780no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11781 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11782 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11783 default value.
11784 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11785 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11786
11787no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11788 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11789 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11790 default value.
11791 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11792 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11793
11794no-ssl
11795 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11796 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11797 default value.
11798 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11799 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11800
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011801no-ssl-reuse
11802 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11803 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11804 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11805 and for paranoid users.
11806
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011807no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011808 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11809 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011810 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011811
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011812 Supported in default-server: No
11813
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011814no-tls-tickets
11815 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11816 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11817 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011818 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11819 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011820 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011821
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011822no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011823 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011824 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11825 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011826 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11827 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011828 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011829
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011830 Supported in default-server: No
11831
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011832no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011833 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011834 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11835 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011836 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11837 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011838 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011839
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011840 Supported in default-server: No
11841
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011842no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011843 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011844 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11845 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011846 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11847 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011848 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011849
11850 Supported in default-server: No
11851
11852no-tlsv13
11853 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11854 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11855 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11856 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11857 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011858 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011859
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011860 Supported in default-server: No
11861
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011862no-verifyhost
11863 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11864 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11865 default value.
11866 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11867 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011868
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011869non-stick
11870 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11871 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11872 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11873
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011874observe <mode>
11875 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11876 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11877 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11878 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11879 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11880 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011881 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011882
11883 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11884
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011885on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011886 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11887 Currently, four modes are available:
11888 - fastinter: force fastinter
11889 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11890 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11891 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11892 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11893
11894 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11895
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011896on-marked-down <action>
11897 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11898 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011899 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11900 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11901 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11902 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11903 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11904 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11905 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11906 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011907
11908 Actions are disabled by default
11909
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011910on-marked-up <action>
11911 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11912 Currently one action is available:
11913 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11914 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11915 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11916 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011917 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11918 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011919 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11920 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11921
11922 Actions are disabled by default
11923
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011924port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011925 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11926 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11927 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11928 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11929 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11930 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11931
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020011932proto <name>
11933
11934 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
11935 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
11936 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
11937 reported in haproxy -vv.
11938 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11939 protocol for all connections established to this server.
11940
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011941redir <prefix>
11942 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11943 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11944 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11945 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11946 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11947 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11948 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11949 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011950 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011951 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011952 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11953 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11954 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11955 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11956
11957 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11958
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011959rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011960 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11961 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11962 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11963
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020011964resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
11965 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
11966 server.
11967
11968 Available options:
11969
11970 * allow-dup-ip
11971 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
11972 resolution at runtime is in operation.
11973 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
11974 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
11975 For such case, simply enable this option.
11976 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
11977
11978 * prevent-dup-ip
11979 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
11980 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
11981 same fqdn.
11982 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
11983
11984 Example:
11985 backend b_myapp
11986 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
11987 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
11988 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
11989
11990 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
11991 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
11992 it
11993 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
11994 different address
11995
11996 Default value: not set
11997
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011998resolve-prefer <family>
11999 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12000 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12001 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12002 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12003
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012004 Default value: ipv6
12005
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012006 Example:
12007
12008 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012009
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012010resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
12011 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
12012 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012013 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012014 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12015 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012016 configured network, another address is selected.
12017
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012018 Example:
12019
12020 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012021
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012022resolvers <id>
12023 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12024 hostname.
12025
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012026 Example:
12027
12028 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012029
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012030 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012031
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012032send-proxy
12033 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12034 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12035 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12036 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012037 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12038 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12039 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12040 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12041 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12042 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12043 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12044 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12045 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12046 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012047 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12048 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012049
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012050send-proxy-v2
12051 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12052 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12053 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12054 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012055 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12056 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12057 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12058 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012059
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012060proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12061 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12062 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012063 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12064 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012065 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12066 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012067 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012068
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012069send-proxy-v2-ssl
12070 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12071 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12072 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12073 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12074 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12075 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12076 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012077 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12078 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012079
12080send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12081 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12082 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12083 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12084 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12085 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12086 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12087 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12088 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012089 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12090 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012091
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012092slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012093 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12094 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12095 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12096 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12097 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12098 parameters :
12099
12100 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12101 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12102
12103 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12104 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12105 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12106 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12107
12108 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12109 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12110 seen as failed.
12111
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012112sni <expression>
12113 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12114 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12115 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12116 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012117 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12118 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012119 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
12120 "verify" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012121
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012122source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012123source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012124source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012125 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12126 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12127 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12128 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12129
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012130 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12131 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12132 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12133 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12134 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12135 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12136 server.
12137
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012138 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12139 specifying the source address without port(s).
12140
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012141ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012142 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12143 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12144 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12145 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12146 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12147 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012148 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12149 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012150
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012151ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12152 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12153 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12154 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12155
12156ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12157 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12158 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12159 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12160
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012161ssl-reuse
12162 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12163 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12164 default value.
12165 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12166 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12167
12168stick
12169 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12170 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12171 default value.
12172 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12173 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012174
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012175tcp-ut <delay>
12176 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12177 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12178 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012179 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012180 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12181 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12182 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12183 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12184 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12185 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12186 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12187 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12188 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12189
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012190track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012191 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12192 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12193 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12194 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012195 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12196
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012197tls-tickets
12198 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12199 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12200 default value.
12201 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12202 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012203
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012204verify [none|required]
12205 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012206 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012207 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12208 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012209 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012210 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12211 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12212 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12213 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12214 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12215 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12216 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12217 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012218
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012219verifyhost <hostname>
12220 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012221 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12222 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12223 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12224 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12225 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12226 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12227 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12228 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012229
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012230weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012231 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12232 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12233 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012234 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12235 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12236 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12237 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12238 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12239 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012240
12241
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200122425.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12243-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012244
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012245HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12246using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12247configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012248This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12249can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12250workload.
12251This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12252resolution at run time.
12253Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12254carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12255
12256
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200122575.3.1. Global overview
12258----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012259
12260As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12261different steps of the process life:
12262
12263 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12264 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12265 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12266
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012267 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12268 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012269
12270A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12271 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12272 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12273 resolution to know this new IP.
12274
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012275When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012276HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012277SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12278from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12279will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12280will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012281
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012282A few things important to notice:
12283 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
12284 first valid response.
12285
12286 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12287 servers return an error.
12288
12289
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200122905.3.2. The resolvers section
12291----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012292
12293This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012294HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12295contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012296
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012297When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12298uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12299is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12300answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12301
12302When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012303used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012304
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012305 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12306 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12307 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012308
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012309 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12310 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012311
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012312 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12313 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12314 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012315
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012316For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12317following scenarios are possible:
12318
12319 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12320 ignored
12321
12322 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12323 applied
12324
12325 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12326 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12327
12328 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12329 retries the query with a new type
12330
12331 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12332 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012333
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012334As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12335a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012336<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012337
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012338
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012339resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012340 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012341
12342A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12343
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012344accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012345 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012346 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012347 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12348 by RFC 6891)
12349
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012350 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12351
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012352nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12353 DNS server description:
12354 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12355 <ip> : IP address of the server
12356 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12357
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012358parse-resolv-conf
12359 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12360 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12361 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12362
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012363hold <status> <period>
12364 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12365 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012366 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012367 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012368 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12369 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12370 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12371
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012372 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012373
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012374resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020012375 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
12376 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
12377 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
12378
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012379resolve_retries <nb>
12380 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12381 giving up.
12382 Default value: 3
12383
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012384 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12385 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12386 type.
12387
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012388timeout <event> <time>
12389 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12390 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12391 events available are:
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012392 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12393 other time applied.
12394 Default value: 1s
12395 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
12396 have been received.
12397 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012398 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12399 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12400
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012401 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012402
12403 resolvers mydns
12404 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12405 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012406 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012407 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012408 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012409 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012410 hold other 30s
12411 hold refused 30s
12412 hold nx 30s
12413 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012414 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012415 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012416
12417
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124186. HTTP header manipulation
12419---------------------------
12420
12421In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12422response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12423request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12424which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012425against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012426
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012427If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12428to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12429but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12430HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12431stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12432because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12433a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12434still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012435
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012436This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12437in section 4.2 :
12438
12439 - reqadd <string>
12440 - reqallow <search>
12441 - reqiallow <search>
12442 - reqdel <search>
12443 - reqidel <search>
12444 - reqdeny <search>
12445 - reqideny <search>
12446 - reqpass <search>
12447 - reqipass <search>
12448 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12449 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12450 - reqtarpit <search>
12451 - reqitarpit <search>
12452 - rspadd <string>
12453 - rspdel <search>
12454 - rspidel <search>
12455 - rspdeny <search>
12456 - rspideny <search>
12457 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12458 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12459
12460With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12461is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12462parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12463prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12464Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12465
12466 \t for a tab
12467 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12468 \n for a new line (LF)
12469 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12470 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12471 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12472 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12473 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12474
12475The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12476portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12477above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12478regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
124799 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12480is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12481
12482The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12483after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12484
12485Notes related to these keywords :
12486---------------------------------
12487 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12488 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12489 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12490
12491 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12492 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12493 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12494
12495 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12496 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12497 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12498 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12499 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12500
12501 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12502 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12503 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12504 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12505 useless headers before adding new ones.
12506
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012507 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012508 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12509
12510 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12511 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12512 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12513
12514 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12515 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012516 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012517
12518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200125197. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12520----------------------------------
12521
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012522HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012523client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12524The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12525these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12526but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12527data called patterns.
12528
12529
125307.1. ACL basics
12531---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012532
12533The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12534content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12535from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12536simple :
12537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012538 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012539 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012540 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12541 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012543The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12544adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012545
12546In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012548 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012549
12550This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12551Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12552and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012553an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12554conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12555as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12556are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012557
12558ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12559'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12560which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12561
12562There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12563performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012565The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12566specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12567this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012568methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12569ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012570
12571Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12572 - boolean
12573 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12574 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12575 - string
12576 - data block
12577
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012578Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12579converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12580would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12581The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12582which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12583
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012584Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12585keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12586fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12587which are summarized in the table below :
12588
12589 +---------------------+-----------------+
12590 | Sample or converter | Default |
12591 | output type | matching method |
12592 +---------------------+-----------------+
12593 | boolean | bool |
12594 +---------------------+-----------------+
12595 | integer | int |
12596 +---------------------+-----------------+
12597 | ip | ip |
12598 +---------------------+-----------------+
12599 | string | str |
12600 +---------------------+-----------------+
12601 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12602 +---------------------+-----------------+
12603
12604Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12605matching method, see below.
12606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012607The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12608 - boolean
12609 - integer or integer range
12610 - IP address / network
12611 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12612 - regular expression
12613 - hex block
12614
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012615The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12616
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012617 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12618 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012619 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012620 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012621 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012622 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012623 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012625The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12626read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12627if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12628lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12629will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12630beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12631a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12632lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12633exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12634
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012635The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12636parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12637ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12638a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12639check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12640
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012641The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12642socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12643file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012645Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12646loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12647
12648 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12649
12650In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12651the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12652case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12653as well.
12654
12655The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12656sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12657do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12658methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12659is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012660obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012661followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12662default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12663that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12664string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12665
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012666The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12667By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12668string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12669resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12670server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12671waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12672flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12673function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012675There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12676sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12677be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012678
12679 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12680 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012681 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12682 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12683 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12684 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012685
12686 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12687 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012688 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012689
12690 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012691 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012692
12693 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012694 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012695
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012696 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012697 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12698
12699 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12700 binary or string samples.
12701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012702 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12703 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012705 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12706 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12707 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012709 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12710 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012712 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12713 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012715 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12716 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012718 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12719 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012720 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012722 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12723 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12724 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012725
12726For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12727request, it is possible to do :
12728
12729 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12730
12731In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12732buffer, one would use the following acl :
12733
12734 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12735
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012736On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12737possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12738
12739 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012741All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12742criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12743method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12744to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12745criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12746the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012748If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012749the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12750For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012752 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12753 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12754 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12755 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012756
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012757
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012758The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12759types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12760combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12761brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12762default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012764 +-------------------------------------------------+
12765 | Input sample type |
12766 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012767 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012768 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12769 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12770 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012771 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012772 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012773 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012774 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012775 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012776 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012777 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012778 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012779 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012780 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012781 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012782 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012783 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012784 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012785 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012786 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012787 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012788 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012789 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012790 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012791 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012792 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12793 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12794 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012795
12796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200127977.1.1. Matching booleans
12798------------------------
12799
12800In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12801Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12802When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12803that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12804
12805Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12806return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12807"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12808
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128107.1.2. Matching integers
12811------------------------
12812
12813Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12814enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12815to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12816
12817Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12818matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12819lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012820
12821For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12822unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12823representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12824
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012825As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12826two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12827instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12828ranges and operators.
12829
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012830For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012831operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12832Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12833of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012834
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012835Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012836
12837 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12838 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12839 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12840 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12841 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12842
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012843For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012844
12845 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12846
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012847This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12848
12849 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12850
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128527.1.3. Matching strings
12853-----------------------
12854
12855String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12856different forms :
12857
12858 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012859 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012860
12861 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012862 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012863
12864 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12865 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12866
12867 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12868 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12869
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012870 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012871 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12872 matches.
12873
12874 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12875 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12876 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012877
12878String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12879exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12880characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12881string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12882to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012883before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012884
12885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128867.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12887---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012888
12889Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12890they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12891possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12892passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12893the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012894the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12895match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012896
12897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128987.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12899-------------------------------------
12900
12901It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12902not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12903a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12904to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12905digits may be used upper or lower case.
12906
12907Example :
12908 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12909 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12910
12911
129127.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12913---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012914
12915IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12916netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12917within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012918host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012919difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12920at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12921does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12922parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012923
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012924The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12925abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12926
12927 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12928 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12929 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12930 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12931 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12932 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12933 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12934 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12935
12936Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12937192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12938
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012939IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12940Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12941trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12942IPv6 patterns.
12943
12944HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12945following situations :
12946 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12947 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12948 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12949 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12950 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12951 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12952 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12953 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12954 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12955 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012957
129587.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12959----------------------------------
12960
12961Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12962combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12963
12964 - AND (implicit)
12965 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12966 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012968A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012970 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012972Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12973indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012975For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12976"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12977requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12978is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12979
12980 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012981 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12982 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12983 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012984
12985To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12986and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12987
12988 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12989 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12990 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12991 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12992
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012993 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012994 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12995 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12996 use_backend www if host_www
12997
12998It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12999expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13000be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13001the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13002
13003 The following rule :
13004
13005 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013006 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013007
13008 Can also be written that way :
13009
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013010 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013011
13012It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13013to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13014simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13015sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13016good use is the following :
13017
13018 With named ACLs :
13019
13020 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13021 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13022 monitor fail if site_dead
13023
13024 With anonymous ACLs :
13025
13026 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13027
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013028See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13029keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013030
13031
130327.3. Fetching samples
13033---------------------
13034
13035Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13036against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13037sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13038ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13039of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13040available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13041
13042This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13043Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13044compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13045deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13046
13047The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13048matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13049method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13050indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13051
13052As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13053when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13054mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13055the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13056ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13057
13058Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13059multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13060when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013061incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13062are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013063is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13064all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13065
13066Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13067 - name
13068 - name(arg1)
13069 - name(arg1,arg2)
13070
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013071
130727.3.1. Converters
13073-----------------
13074
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013075Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13076of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13077is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13078was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013079has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013080unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13081
13082These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13083sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13084the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013085support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013086
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013087A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13088support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13089supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13090(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13091bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013093The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013094
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001309551d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13096 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13097 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13098 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13099 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13100 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13101
13102 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013103 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13104 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013105 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13106 frontend http-in
13107 bind *:8081
13108 default_backend servers
13109 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13110 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13111
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013112add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013113 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013114 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013115 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13116 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013117 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013118 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13119 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13120 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13121 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013122 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013123 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013124
13125and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013126 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013127 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013128 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13129 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013130 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013131 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13132 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13133 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13134 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013135 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013136 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013137
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013138b64dec
13139 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13140 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13141
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013142base64
13143 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013144 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013145 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13146
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013147bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013148 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013149 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013150 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013151 presence of a flag).
13152
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013153bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13154 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13155 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013156 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013157
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013158concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13159 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13160 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13161 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13162 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13163 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13164 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13165 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13166 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13167 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13168 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
13169 other variables, such as colon-delimited varlues. Note that due to the config
13170 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
13171 delimitors.
13172
13173 Example:
13174 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13175 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13176 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13177 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13178
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013179cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013180 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13181 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013182
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013183crc32([<avalanche>])
13184 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13185 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13186 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13187 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13188 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13189 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13190 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13191 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13192 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13193 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013194 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13195
13196crc32c([<avalanche>])
13197 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13198 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13199 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13200 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13201 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13202 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13203 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13204 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013205
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013206da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013207 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13208 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13209 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13210 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013211 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013212 configuration language.
13213
13214 Example:
13215 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013216 bind *:8881
13217 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013218 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013219
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013220debug
13221 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13222 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13223 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13224
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013225div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013226 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13227 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013228 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013229 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13230 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013231 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013232 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13233 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13234 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13235 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013236 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013237 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013238
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013239djb2([<avalanche>])
13240 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13241 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13242 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13243 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13244 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13245 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13246 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013247 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13248 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013249
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013250even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013251 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013252 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13253
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013254field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13255 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13256 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13257 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13258 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13259 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13260 fields.
13261
13262 Example :
13263 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13264 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13265 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13266 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13267 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013268
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013269hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013270 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013271 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013272 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013273 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013274
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013275hex2i
13276 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
13277 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
13278
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013279http_date([<offset>])
13280 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13281 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13282 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13283 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13284 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13285 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013286
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013287in_table(<table>)
13288 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13289 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13290 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013291 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013292 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13293
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013294ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13295 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013296 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013297 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13298 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13299 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13300 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13301 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013302
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013303json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013304 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013305 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013306 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013307 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13308 of errors:
13309 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13310 bytes, ...)
13311 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13312 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13313
13314 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13315 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13316 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13317 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13318 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13319 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013320 - "ascii" : never fails;
13321 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13322 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013323 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013324 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013325 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13326 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13327
13328 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013329 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013330
13331 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013332 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013333 capture request header user-agent len 150
13334 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013335
13336 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13337 GET / HTTP/1.0
13338 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13339
13340 Output log:
13341 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13342
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013343language(<value>[,<default>])
13344 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13345 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13346 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13347 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13348 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13349 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13350 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13351 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13352 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013353 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013354 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13355 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013356
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013357 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013358
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013359 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13360 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013361
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013362 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13363 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13364 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13365 use_backend spanish if es
13366 use_backend french if fr
13367 use_backend english if en
13368 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013369
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013370length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013371 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13372 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13373 type. The result is of type integer.
13374
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013375lower
13376 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13377 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13378 type. The result is of type string.
13379
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013380ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13381 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13382 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13383 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13384 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13385 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13386 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13387
13388 Example :
13389
13390 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013391 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013392 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13393
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013394map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13395map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13396map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13397 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13398 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13399 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13400 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13401 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13402 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13403 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13404 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013405
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013406 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13407 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13408 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013409
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013410 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013411 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013412
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013413 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13414 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13415 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13416 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013417 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13418 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013419 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13420 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13421 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13422 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13423 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13424 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13425 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13426 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013427 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13428 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13429 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013430 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13431 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13432 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13433 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13434 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013435
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013436 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13437 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13438 the corresponding match text.
13439
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013440 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13441 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13442 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13443 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13444 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013445
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013446 Example :
13447
13448 # this is a comment and is ignored
13449 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13450 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13451 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13452 | | | `---------- value
13453 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13454 | `---------------------------- key
13455 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13456
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013457mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013458 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13459 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013460 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013461 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013462 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013463 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13464 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13465 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13466 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013467 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013468 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013469
13470mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013471 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013472 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13473 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013474 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013475 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013476 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013477 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13478 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13479 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13480 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013481 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013482 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013483
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013484nbsrv
13485 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13486 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13487 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13488 map lookup.
13489
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013490neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013491 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13492 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13493 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13494 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013495
13496not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013497 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013498 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013499 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013500 absence of a flag).
13501
13502odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013503 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013504 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13505
13506or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013507 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013508 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013509 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13510 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013511 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013512 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13513 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13514 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13515 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013516 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013517 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013518
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013519regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013520 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13521 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13522 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13523 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13524 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13525 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13526 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13527 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13528 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13529 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013530 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13531 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13532 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13533 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013534
13535 Example :
13536
13537 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13538 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13539 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13540 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13541
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013542capture-req(<id>)
13543 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13544 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13545
13546 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013547 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13548 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013549
13550capture-res(<id>)
13551 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13552 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13553
13554 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013555 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13556 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013557
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013558sdbm([<avalanche>])
13559 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13560 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13561 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13562 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13563 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13564 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13565 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013566 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13567 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013568
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013569set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013570 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13571 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13572 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013573 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013574 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13575 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013576 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013577 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13578 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013579 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013580 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013581
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013582sha1
13583 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13584 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13585
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013586strcmp(<var>)
13587 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13588 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13589 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13590 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13591 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13592 shorter).
13593
13594 Example :
13595
13596 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13597 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13598 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13599
13600
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013601sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013602 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13603 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013604 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013605 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13606 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013607 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013608 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13609 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013610 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013611 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13612 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013613 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013614 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013615
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013616table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13617 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13618 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13619 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13620 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13621 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13622 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13623
13624
13625table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13626 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13627 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13628 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13629 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13630 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13631 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13632
13633table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13634 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13635 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013636 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013637 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13638 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13639
13640table_conn_cur(<table>)
13641 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13642 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13643 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13644 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13645 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13646
13647table_conn_rate(<table>)
13648 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13649 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13650 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13651 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13652 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13653
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013654table_gpt0(<table>)
13655 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13656 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13657 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13658 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13659 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13660
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013661table_gpc0(<table>)
13662 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13663 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13664 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13665 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13666 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13667
13668table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13669 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13670 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13671 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13672 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13673 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13674 sample fetch keyword.
13675
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013676table_gpc1(<table>)
13677 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13678 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13679 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13680 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13681 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13682
13683table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13684 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13685 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13686 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13687 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13688 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13689 sample fetch keyword.
13690
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013691table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13692 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13693 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013694 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013695 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13696 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13697
13698table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13699 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13700 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13701 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13702 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13703 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13704 keyword.
13705
13706table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13707 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13708 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013709 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013710 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13711 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13712
13713table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13714 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13715 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13716 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13717 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13718 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13719 keyword.
13720
13721table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13722 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13723 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013724 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013725 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13726 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13727 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13728 keyword.
13729
13730table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13731 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13732 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013733 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013734 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13735 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13736 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13737 keyword.
13738
13739table_server_id(<table>)
13740 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13741 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13742 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13743 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13744 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13745 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13746
13747table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13748 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13749 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013750 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013751 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13752 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13753 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13754 keyword.
13755
13756table_sess_rate(<table>)
13757 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13758 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13759 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13760 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13761 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13762 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13763 keyword.
13764
13765table_trackers(<table>)
13766 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13767 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13768 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13769 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13770 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13771 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13772 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13773 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13774 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13775 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13776
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013777upper
13778 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13779 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13780 type. The result is of type string.
13781
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013782url_dec
13783 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13784 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13785
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013786unset-var(<var name>)
13787 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13788 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13789 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13790 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13791 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13792 response),
13793 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13794 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13795 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13796 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13797
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013798utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13799 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13800 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13801 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13802 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13803 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13804 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13805
13806 Example :
13807
13808 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013809 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013810 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13811
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013812word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13813 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
13814 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
13815 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13816 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
13817 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
13818
13819 Example :
13820 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
13821 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13822 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
13823 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
13824 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013825
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013826wt6([<avalanche>])
13827 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13828 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13829 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13830 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13831 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13832 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13833 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013834 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
13835 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013836
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013837xor(<value>)
13838 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013839 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013840 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013841 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013842 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013843 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13844 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013845 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013846 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13847 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013848 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013849 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013850
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013851xxh32([<seed>])
13852 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13853 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13854 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13855 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13856 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13857 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13858 as cryptographically secure.
13859
13860xxh64([<seed>])
13861 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
13862 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13863 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13864 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13865 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13866 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13867 as cryptographically secure.
13868
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013869
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200138707.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013871--------------------------------------------
13872
13873A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
13874not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
13875"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
13876The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
13877
13878always_false : boolean
13879 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13880 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13881
13882always_true : boolean
13883 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13884 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13885
13886avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013887 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013888 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
13889 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
13890 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
13891 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
13892 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
13893 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
13894 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
13895 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
13896 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
13897 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
13898 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
13899 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
13900 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010013901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013902be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013903 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
13904 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
13905 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
13906 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040013907 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
13908
13909be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
13910 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
13911 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
13912 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
13913 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
13914 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040013915 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
13916 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040013917
13918 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
13919 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
13920 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013922be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
13923 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13924 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13925 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013926 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013927 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
13928 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013929
13930 Example :
13931 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
13932 backend dynamic
13933 mode http
13934 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
13935 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013936
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013937bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013938 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
13939 of the string.
13940
13941bool(<bool>) : bool
13942 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
13943 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
13944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013945connslots([<backend>]) : integer
13946 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013947 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013948 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
13949 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050013950
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013951 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013952 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013953 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
13954
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013955 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
13956 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013957
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013958 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013959 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013960 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013961 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013962 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013963 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013964 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013965
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013966 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
13967 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013968 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013969 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013970
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010013971cpu_calls : integer
13972 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
13973 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
13974 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
13975 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
13976 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
13977 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
13978
13979cpu_ns_avg : integer
13980 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
13981 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
13982 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
13983 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
13984 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
13985 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
13986 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
13987 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
13988 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
13989 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
13990 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
13991
13992cpu_ns_tot : integer
13993 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
13994 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
13995 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
13996 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
13997 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
13998 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
13999 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14000 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14001 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14002 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14003 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14004 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14005 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14006
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014007date([<offset>]) : integer
14008 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14009 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14010 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14011 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014012 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14013
14014 Example :
14015
14016 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14017 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014018
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014019date_us : integer
14020 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14021 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14022 from the same timeval structure.
14023
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014024distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14025 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14026 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14027 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14028 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14029 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14030 list of supported tokens.
14031
14032distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14033 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14034 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14035 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14036 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14037 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14038 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14039 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14040 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14041 supported tokens.
14042
14043 Example :
14044 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14045 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14046 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14047 # send large files to the big farm
14048 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14049
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014050env(<name>) : string
14051 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14052 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14053 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14054 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14055 certain way.
14056
14057 Examples :
14058 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14059 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14060
14061 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14062 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014064fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14065 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014066 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14067 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014068 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14069 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014070 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014071 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14072 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014073
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014074fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14075 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14076 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14077 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014079fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14080 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14081 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14082 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14083 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14084 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14085 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14086 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14087 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014088
14089 Example :
14090 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14091 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14092 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14093 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14094 frontend mail
14095 bind :25
14096 mode tcp
14097 maxconn 100
14098 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14099 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14100 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14101 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014102
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014103hostname : string
14104 Returns the system hostname.
14105
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014106int(<integer>) : signed integer
14107 Returns a signed integer.
14108
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014109ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14110 Returns an ipv4.
14111
14112ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14113 Returns an ipv6.
14114
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014115lat_ns_avg : integer
14116 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14117 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14118 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14119 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14120 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14121 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14122 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14123 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14124 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14125 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14126 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14127 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14128 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14129 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14130
14131lat_ns_tot : integer
14132 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14133 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14134 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14135 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14136 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14137 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14138 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14139 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14140 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14141 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14142 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14143 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14144 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14145 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14146 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14147 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14148 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14149 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14150 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14151
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014152meth(<method>) : method
14153 Returns a method.
14154
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014155nbproc : integer
14156 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14157 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14158 and debugging purposes.
14159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014160nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14161 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14162 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14163 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014164 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14165 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14166 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014167
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014168prio_class : integer
14169 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14170 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14171 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14172
14173prio_offset : integer
14174 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14175 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14176 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14177 set-priority-offset".
14178
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014179proc : integer
14180 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14181 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14182 debugging purposes.
14183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014184queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014185 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14186 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14187 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014188 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14189 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14190 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14191 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14192 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14193
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014194rand([<range>]) : integer
14195 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14196 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14197 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14198 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14199 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014201srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14202 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14203 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14204 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14205 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14206 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014207 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14208 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14209
14210srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14211 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14212 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14213 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14214 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14215 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14216 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14217 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14218
14219 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14220 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014221
14222srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14223 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14224 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14225 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014226 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014227 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14228 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14229 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14230
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014231srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14232 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14233 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14234 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14235 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14236 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14237 fetch methods.
14238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014239srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14240 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14241 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014242 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014243 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14244 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014245 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014246 overloading servers).
14247
14248 Example :
14249 # Redirect to a separate back
14250 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14251 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14252 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14253
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014254stopping : boolean
14255 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14256 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14257 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14258
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014259str(<string>) : string
14260 Returns a string.
14261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014262table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14263 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14264 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14265
14266table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14267 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14268 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14269 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14270
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014271thread : integer
14272 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14273 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14274 and debugging purposes.
14275
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014276var(<var-name>) : undefined
14277 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014278 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14279 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014280 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014281 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14282 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014283 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014284 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14285 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014286 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014287 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014288
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200142897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014290----------------------------------
14291
14292The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14293closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14294methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14295sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14296TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014297the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14298counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014299"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14300used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14301can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14302Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14303table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14304tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14305currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014306
14307be_id : integer
14308 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14309 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14310
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014311be_name : string
14312 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14313 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014315dst : ip
14316 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14317 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14318 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14319 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
14320 RFC 4291.
14321
14322dst_conn : integer
14323 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14324 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14325 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14326 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14327 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14328 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14329 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14330 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014331
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014332dst_is_local : boolean
14333 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14334 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14335 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14336 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014337 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014338 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14339 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14340 it only once per connection.
14341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014342dst_port : integer
14343 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14344 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14345 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14346 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14347 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14348 an HTTP header.
14349
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014350fc_http_major : integer
14351 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14352 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14353 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14354
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014355fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14356 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14357 header.
14358
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014359fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14360 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14361 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14362 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14363 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14364 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14365 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14366
14367fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14368 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14369 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14370 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14371 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14372 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14373 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14374
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014375fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
14376 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14377 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14378 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14379 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14380
14381fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
14382 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14383 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14384 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14385 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14386
14387fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
14388 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14389 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14390 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14391 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14392
14393fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
14394 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14395 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14396 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14397 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14398
14399fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
14400 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14401 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14402 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14403 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14404
14405fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
14406 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14407 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14408 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14409 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14410
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014411fe_defbe : string
14412 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14413 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014415fe_id : integer
14416 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014417 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014418 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14419
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014420fe_name : string
14421 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14422 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14423 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14424
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014425sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014426sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14427sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14428sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014429 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14430 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14431 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14432
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014433sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014434sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14435sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14436sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014437 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14438 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14439 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14440
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014441sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014442sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14443sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14444sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014445 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14446 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014447 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14448 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14449 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014450
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014451 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014452 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14453 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014454 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14455 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14456 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014457 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14458 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14459
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014460sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14461sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14462sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14463sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14464 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14465 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14466 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14467 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14468 when a first ACL was verified.
14469
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014470sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014471sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14472sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14473sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014474 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014475 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14476
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014477sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014478sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14479sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14480sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014481 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14482 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14483 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14484
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014485sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014486sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14487sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14488sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014489 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14490 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14491 See also src_conn_rate.
14492
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014493sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014494sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14495sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14496sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014497 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014498 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014499
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014500sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14501sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14502sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14503sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14504 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14505 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14506
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014507sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14508sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14509sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14510sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14511 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14512 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14513
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014514sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014515sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14516sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14517sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014518 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14519 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14520 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014521 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14522 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14523 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014524
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014525sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14526sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14527sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14528sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14529 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14530 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14531 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14532 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14533 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14534 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14535
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014536sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014537sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14538sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14539sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014540 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014541 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14542 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14543
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014544sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014545sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14546sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14547sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014548 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14549 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14550 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14551 src_http_err_rate.
14552
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014553sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014554sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14555sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14556sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014557 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014558 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14559 src_http_req_cnt.
14560
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014561sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014562sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14563sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14564sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014565 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14566 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14567 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14568 src_http_req_rate.
14569
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014570sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014571sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14572sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14573sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014574 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014575 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14576 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14577 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14578 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014579
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014580 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014581 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14582 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014583 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14584
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014585sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14586sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14587sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14588sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14589 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14590 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14591 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14592 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14593 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14594
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014595sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014596sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14597sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14598sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014599 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14600 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14601 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014602
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014603sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014604sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14605sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14606sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014607 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14608 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14609 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014610
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014611sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014612sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14613sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14614sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014615 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014616 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14617 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14618 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014619 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014620 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14621
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014622sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014623sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14624sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14625sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014626 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14627 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14628 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14629 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14630 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014631 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014632
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014633sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014634sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14635sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14636sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014637 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14638 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14639 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14640
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014641sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014642sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14643sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14644sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014645 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14646 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014647 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014648 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14649 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014650 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14651 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14652 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014654so_id : integer
14655 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14656 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14657 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014659src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014660 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014661 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14662 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14663 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014664 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14665 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14666 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
14667 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014668
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014669 Example:
14670 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14671 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014673src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14674 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14675 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14676 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014677 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014679src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14680 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14681 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014682 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014683 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014685src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14686 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14687 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14688 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14689 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14690 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14691 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014692
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014693 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014694 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14695 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14696 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14697 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014698 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014699 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14700 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14701
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014702src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14703 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14704 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14705 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14706 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14707 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14708 was verified.
14709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014710src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014711 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014712 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014713 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014714 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014716src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014717 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014718 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14719 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014720 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014722src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14723 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14724 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14725 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014726 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014728src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014729 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014730 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014731 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014732 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014733
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014734src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14735 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14736 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14737 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14738 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
14739
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014740src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14741 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14742 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14743 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14744 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014746src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014747 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014748 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014749 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14750 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014751 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14752 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14753 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014754
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014755src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14756 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14757 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14758 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14759 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14760 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14761 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14762 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014764src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014765 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014766 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014767 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014768 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014769 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014771src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14772 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14773 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14774 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14775 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014776 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014778src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014779 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014780 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14781 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014782 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014784src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14785 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14786 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14787 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014788 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014789 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014791src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14792 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14793 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14794 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014795 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014796 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14797 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014798
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014799 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014800 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014801 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014802 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014803
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014804src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14805 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14806 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14807 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
14808 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14809 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14810 connection when a first ACL was verified.
14811
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014812src_is_local : boolean
14813 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
14814 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
14815 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
14816 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014817 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014818 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
14819 once per connection.
14820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014821src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014822 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
14823 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
14824 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
14825 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
14826 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014828src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014829 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
14830 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14831 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
14832 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
14833 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014835src_port : integer
14836 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
14837 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
14838 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
14839 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014841src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014842 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014843 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14844 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
14845 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014846 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014848src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14849 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
14850 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14851 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14852 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014853 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014855src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14856 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
14857 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
14858 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
14859 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
14860 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
14861 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
14862 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
14863 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014864
14865 Example :
14866 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
14867 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
14868 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
14869 listen ssh
14870 bind :22
14871 mode tcp
14872 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014873 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014874 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014875 server local 127.0.0.1:22
14876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014877srv_id : integer
14878 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
14879 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
14880 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020014881
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200148827.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014883----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020014884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014885The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
14886closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
14887when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
14888usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014889future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014890
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001489151d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
14892 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14893 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14894 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
14895 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14896 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14897
14898 Example :
14899 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
14900 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
14901 # the request.
14902 frontend http-in
14903 bind *:8081
14904 default_backend servers
14905 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14906 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14907
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014908ssl_bc : boolean
14909 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14910 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
14911 other a server with the "ssl" option.
14912
14913ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
14914 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
14915 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14916
14917ssl_bc_cipher : string
14918 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
14919 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14920
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010014921ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
14922 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14923 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
14924 session or a TLS ticket.
14925
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014926ssl_bc_protocol : string
14927 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
14928 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14929
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014930ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014931 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014932 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14933 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014934
14935ssl_bc_session_id : binary
14936 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
14937 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
14938 if session was reused or not.
14939
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040014940ssl_bc_session_key : binary
14941 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
14942 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
14943 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
14944 BoringSSL.
14945
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014946ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
14947 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
14948 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014950ssl_c_ca_err : integer
14951 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14952 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
14953 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
14954 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
14955 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014957ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
14958 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14959 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
14960 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
14961 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014962
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014963ssl_c_der : binary
14964 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
14965 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14966 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014968ssl_c_err : integer
14969 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14970 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
14971 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
14972 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
14973 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014975ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14976 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14977 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14978 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14979 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14980 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14981 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14982 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14983 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014985ssl_c_key_alg : string
14986 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14987 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14988 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014990ssl_c_notafter : string
14991 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
14992 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14993 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014995ssl_c_notbefore : string
14996 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
14997 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14998 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015000ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15001 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15002 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15003 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15004 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15005 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15006 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15007 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15008 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015010ssl_c_serial : binary
15011 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15012 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15013 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015015ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15016 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15017 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15018 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015019 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15020 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15021
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015022 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015023 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015025ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15026 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15027 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15028 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015030ssl_c_used : boolean
15031 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15032 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015034ssl_c_verify : integer
15035 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15036 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15037 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15038 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015040ssl_c_version : integer
15041 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15042 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015043
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015044ssl_f_der : binary
15045 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15046 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15047 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015049ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15050 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15051 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15052 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15053 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015054 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015055 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15056 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15057 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015059ssl_f_key_alg : string
15060 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15061 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15062 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015064ssl_f_notafter : string
15065 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15066 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15067 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015069ssl_f_notbefore : string
15070 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15071 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15072 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015074ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15075 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15076 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15077 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15078 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15079 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15080 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15081 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15082 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015084ssl_f_serial : binary
15085 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15086 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15087 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015088
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015089ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15090 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15091 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15092 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015094ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15095 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15096 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15097 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015099ssl_f_version : integer
15100 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15101 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15102
15103ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015104 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15105 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15106 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015108 Example :
15109 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15110 listen http-https
15111 bind :80
15112 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15113 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15114
15115ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15116 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15117 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15118
15119ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015120 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015121 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15122 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15123 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15124 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15125 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15126 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15127 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15128 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015130ssl_fc_cipher : string
15131 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15132 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015133
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015134ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15135 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15136 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015137 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015138
15139ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15140 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15141 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015142 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015143
15144ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15145 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15146 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15147 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015148 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015149 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015150
15151ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15152 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15153 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015154 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015156ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015157 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15158 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015159 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15160 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15161 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15162 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015163
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015164ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15165 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15166 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15167 wait until the handshake happened.
15168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015169ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15170 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015171 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15172 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
15173 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15174 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015175
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015176ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015177 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015178 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15179 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015181ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015182 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015183 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15184 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15185 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15186 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15187 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15188 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15189 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015191ssl_fc_protocol : string
15192 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15193 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015194
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015195ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015196 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015197 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15198 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015200ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15201 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15202 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15203 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15204 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015205
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015206ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15207 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15208 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15209 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15210 BoringSSL.
15211
15212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015213ssl_fc_sni : string
15214 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15215 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15216 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15217 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15218 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15219
15220 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15221 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15222 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015223 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
15224 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015226 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015227 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15228 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015230ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15231 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15232 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015233
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015234
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200152357.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015236------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015238Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15239sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15240only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15241For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15242be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15243can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15244sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15245for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15246content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015248payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015249 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015250 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15251 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015253payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15254 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015255 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015256 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015257
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015258req.hdrs : string
15259 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15260 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15261 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15262 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15263
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015264req.hdrs_bin : binary
15265 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15266 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15267 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15268 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15269 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15270 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15271
15272 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15273
15274 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15275 str: <int:length><bytes>
15276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015277req.len : integer
15278req_len : integer (deprecated)
15279 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15280 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15281 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15282 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15283 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15284 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15285 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15286 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015288req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15289 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015290 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15291 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15292 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15293 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015295 ACL alternatives :
15296 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015298req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15299 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15300 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15301 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15302 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015304 ACL alternatives :
15305 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015307 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015309req.proto_http : boolean
15310req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15311 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15312 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15313 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15314 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15315 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15316 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15317 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015319 Example:
15320 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15321 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15322 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015323 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015325req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15326rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15327 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15328 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15329 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15330 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15331 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15332 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15333 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015335 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15336 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15337 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15338 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15339 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15340 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015342 ACL derivatives :
15343 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015345 Example :
15346 listen tse-farm
15347 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15348 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15349 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15350 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15351 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15352 persist rdp-cookie
15353 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15354 # This is only useful makes sense if
15355 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15356 stick-table type string size 204800
15357 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15358 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15359 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015361 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15362 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015364req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15365rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15366 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15367 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15368 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15369 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015371 ACL derivatives :
15372 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015373
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015374req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15375 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15376 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015377 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15378 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15379 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15380 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15381 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015383req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15384req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15385 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15386 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15387 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15388 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15389 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15390 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15391 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015393req.ssl_sni : string
15394req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15395 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15396 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15397 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15398 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15399 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15400 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15401 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15402 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15403 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15404 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15405 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15406 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015408 ACL derivatives :
15409 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015411 Examples :
15412 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15413 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15414 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15415 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15416 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015417
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015418req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15419 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15420 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15421 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15422 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15423 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15424 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15425 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15426 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15427 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015429req.ssl_ver : integer
15430req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15431 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15432 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15433 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15434 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15435 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15436 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15437 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015438 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015439 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015441 ACL derivatives :
15442 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015443
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015444res.len : integer
15445 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15446 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15447 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15448 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15449 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15450 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15451 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15452 content inspection.
15453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015454res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15455 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015456 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15457 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15458 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15459 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015461res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15462 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15463 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15464 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15465 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015467 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015468
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015469res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15470rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15471 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15472 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15473 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15474 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15475 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15476 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15477 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015479wait_end : boolean
15480 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15481 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015482 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015483 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15484 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015485 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015486 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15487 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015489 Examples :
15490 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15491 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15492 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015494 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15495 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15496 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15497 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15498 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15499 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15500 tcp-request content reject
15501
15502
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200155037.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015504--------------------------------------
15505
15506It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15507This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15508data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15509its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15510HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15511content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15512to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15513more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15514response are indexed.
15515
15516base : string
15517 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15518 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15519 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15520 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15521 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15522 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15523 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15524 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15525
15526 ACL derivatives :
15527 base : exact string match
15528 base_beg : prefix match
15529 base_dir : subdir match
15530 base_dom : domain match
15531 base_end : suffix match
15532 base_len : length match
15533 base_reg : regex match
15534 base_sub : substring match
15535
15536base32 : integer
15537 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15538 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15539 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015540 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15541 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15542 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015543
15544base32+src : binary
15545 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15546 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15547 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15548 per-URL counters.
15549
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015550capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15551 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15552 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15553 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15554
15555capture.req.method : string
15556 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15557 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15558 because it's allocated.
15559
15560capture.req.uri : string
15561 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15562 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15563 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15564 allocated.
15565
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015566capture.req.ver : string
15567 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15568 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15569 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15570
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015571capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15572 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15573 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15574 The first entry is an index of 0.
15575 See also: "capture response header"
15576
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015577capture.res.ver : string
15578 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15579 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15580 persistent flag.
15581
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015582req.body : binary
15583 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15584 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15585 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15586 the first chunk is analyzed.
15587
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015588req.body_param([<name>) : string
15589 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15590 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15591 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15592 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15593 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15594 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15595 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15596 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15597 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15598 given.
15599
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015600req.body_len : integer
15601 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15602 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15603 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15604 "option http-buffer-request".
15605
15606req.body_size : integer
15607 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15608 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15609 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15610 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15611 "option http-buffer-request".
15612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015613req.cook([<name>]) : string
15614cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15615 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15616 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15617 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15618 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15619 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15620 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15621 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15622 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15623
15624 ACL derivatives :
15625 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15626 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15627 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15628 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15629 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15630 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15631 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15632 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015634req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15635cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15636 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15637 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015639req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15640cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15641 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15642 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15643 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15644 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015646cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15647 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15648 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
15649 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
15650 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015651 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015652 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
15653 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
15654 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
15655 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015657hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15658 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
15659 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
15660 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
15661 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015662 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015664req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
15665 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15666 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15667 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15668 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15669 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15670 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
15671 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
15672 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015674req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15675 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15676 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15677 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15678 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015680req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15681 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15682 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15683 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15684 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15685 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15686 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
15687 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
15688 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000015689 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015690 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015691 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015693 ACL derivatives :
15694 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15695 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15696 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15697 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15698 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15699 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15700 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15701 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15702
15703req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15704hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
15705 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15706 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
15707 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
15708 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
15709 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
15710 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
15711 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
15712 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
15713 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
15714
15715req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15716hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15717 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
15718 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
15719 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
15720 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15721 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015722 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015723 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
15724 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
15725
15726req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15727hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15728 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
15729 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
15730 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
15731 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15732 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15733 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15734 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
15735
15736http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
15737 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
15738 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
15739 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15740 basic auth is supported.
15741
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015742http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
15743 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
15744 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
15745 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
15746 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015747 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15748 basic auth is supported.
15749
15750 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015751 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
15752 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
15753 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
15754 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015755
15756http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015757 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
15758 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015759 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
15760 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015762method : integer + string
15763 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
15764 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
15765 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
15766 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
15767 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
15768 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
15769 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015771 ACL derivatives :
15772 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015774 Example :
15775 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
15776 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
15777 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015779path : string
15780 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
15781 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
15782 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
15783 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
15784 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015785 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015786 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015788 ACL derivatives :
15789 path : exact string match
15790 path_beg : prefix match
15791 path_dir : subdir match
15792 path_dom : domain match
15793 path_end : suffix match
15794 path_len : length match
15795 path_reg : regex match
15796 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015797
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015798query : string
15799 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
15800 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
15801 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
15802 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015803 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015804 which stops before the question mark.
15805
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015806req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15807 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15808 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15809 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15810 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015812req.ver : string
15813req_ver : string (deprecated)
15814 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
15815 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
15816 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015818 ACL derivatives :
15819 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015821res.comp : boolean
15822 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
15823 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
15824 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015826res.comp_algo : string
15827 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
15828 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
15829 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015831res.cook([<name>]) : string
15832scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15833 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15834 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15835 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015837 ACL derivatives :
15838 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015840res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15841scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15842 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15843 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
15844 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015846res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15847scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15848 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15849 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
15850 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015852res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15853 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15854 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15855 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15856 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15857 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
15858 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
15859 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
15860 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
15861 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015863res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15864 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15865 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15866 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15867 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
15868 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015870res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15871shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
15872 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15873 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15874 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15875 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15876 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
15877 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
15878 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
15879 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015881 ACL derivatives :
15882 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15883 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15884 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15885 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15886 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15887 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15888 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15889 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15890
15891res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15892shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15893 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15894 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15895 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
15896 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
15897 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015899res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15900shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15901 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
15902 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
15903 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
15904 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
15905 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
15906 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015907
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015908res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15909 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15910 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15911 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15912 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015914res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15915shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15916 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
15917 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15918 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
15919 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
15920 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
15921 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015923res.ver : string
15924resp_ver : string (deprecated)
15925 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
15926 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015928 ACL derivatives :
15929 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015931set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15932 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15933 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015934 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015935 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015937 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
15938 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015940status : integer
15941 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
15942 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
15943 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015944
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020015945unique-id : string
15946 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
15947 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
15948 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
15949 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
15950 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
15951 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
15952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015953url : string
15954 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
15955 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
15956 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
15957 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
15958 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
15959 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
15960 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015962 ACL derivatives :
15963 url : exact string match
15964 url_beg : prefix match
15965 url_dir : subdir match
15966 url_dom : domain match
15967 url_end : suffix match
15968 url_len : length match
15969 url_reg : regex match
15970 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015972url_ip : ip
15973 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
15974 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
15975 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
15976 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
15977 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
15978 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15979 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015981url_port : integer
15982 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
15983 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
15984 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15985 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015986
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015987urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
15988url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015989 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
15990 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015991 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
15992 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
15993 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
15994 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015995 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
15996 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015997 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
15998 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016000 ACL derivatives :
16001 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16002 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16003 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16004 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16005 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16006 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16007 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16008 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016009
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016011 Example :
16012 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16013 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16014 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16015 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016016
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016017urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016018 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16019 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16020 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016021
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016022url32 : integer
16023 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16024 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16025 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16026 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16027 is an unsigned integer.
16028
16029url32+src : binary
16030 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16031 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16032 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16033
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200160357.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016036---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016037
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016038Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16039every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016040order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016041
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016042ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16043---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016044FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016045HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016046HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16047HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016048HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16049HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16050HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16051HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16052LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016053METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016054METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016055METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16056METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16057METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16058METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016059METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016060METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016061RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016062REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016063TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016064WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16065---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016066
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016067
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160688. Logging
16069----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016070
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016071One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16072provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16073very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16074provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16075state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016076to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016077headers.
16078
16079In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16080about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16081send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16082
16083 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16084 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16085 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16086 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16087 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016088 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016089 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016090
16091The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16092allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16093as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16094while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16095real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16096delay.
16097
16098
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160998.1. Log levels
16100---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016101
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016102TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016103source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016104HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16105in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16106track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16107syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16108about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016109
16110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161118.2. Log formats
16112----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016113
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016114HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016115and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16116slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16117options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016118
16119 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16120 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16121 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16122 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16123 extents.
16124
16125 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16126 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16127 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16128 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16129 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16130
16131 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16132 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16133 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16134 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16135 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16136
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016137 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16138 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16139 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16140 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16141
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016142 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16143
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016144Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16145specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16146field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16147servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16148always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16149identifier.
16150
16151Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16152 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16153 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16154 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16155 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16156
16157
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161588.2.1. Default log format
16159-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016160
16161This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16162as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16163format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16164
16165 Example :
16166 listen www
16167 mode http
16168 log global
16169 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16170
16171 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16172 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16173 (www/HTTP)
16174
16175 Field Format Extract from the example above
16176 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16177 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16178 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16179 4 'to' to
16180 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16181 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16182
16183Detailed fields description :
16184 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16185 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16186 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16187 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16188 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16189 and processed the connection.
16190 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16191
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016192In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16193"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16194connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16195
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016196It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16197will eventually disappear.
16198
16199
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162008.2.2. TCP log format
16201---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016202
16203The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16204is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16205information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16206counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16207emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16208environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16209the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16210sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016211specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16212not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16213fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16214marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016215
16216 Example :
16217 frontend fnt
16218 mode tcp
16219 option tcplog
16220 log global
16221 default_backend bck
16222
16223 backend bck
16224 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16225
16226 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16227 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16228 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16229
16230 Field Format Extract from the example above
16231 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16232 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16233 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16234 4 frontend_name fnt
16235 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16236 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16237 7 bytes_read* 212
16238 8 termination_state --
16239 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16240 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16241
16242Detailed fields description :
16243 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016244 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16245 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16246 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016247 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016248 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016249 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016250
16251 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016252 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16253 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16254 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016255
16256 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16257 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16258 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016259 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16260 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16261 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16262 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016263
16264 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16265 and processed the connection.
16266
16267 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16268 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16269 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16270 applications.
16271
16272 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16273 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16274 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16275 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16276 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16277
16278 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16279 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16280 See "Timers" below for more details.
16281
16282 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16283 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16284 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16285 "Timers" below for more details.
16286
16287 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016288 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016289 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16290 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16291 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16292 details.
16293
16294 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16295 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16296 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16297 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16298 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16299
16300 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16301 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16302 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16303 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16304 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16305 for more details.
16306
16307 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016308 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016309 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16310 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16311 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016312 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016313
16314 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16315 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16316 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16317 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16318 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16319 caused by a denial of service attack.
16320
16321 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16322 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16323 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16324 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16325 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16326 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16327 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16328 denial of service attack.
16329
16330 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16331 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16332 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16333 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16334 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16335 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16336 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16337 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16338 be processed than on other servers.
16339
16340 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16341 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16342 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16343 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16344 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16345 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16346 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16347 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16348 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16349 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16350 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16351 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16352 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16353
16354 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16355 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16356 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16357 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16358 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16359 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016360 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016361 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16362
16363 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16364 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16365 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16366 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16367 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16368 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016369 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016370 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16371 occurs.
16372
16373
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163748.2.3. HTTP log format
16375----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016376
16377The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16378is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16379the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16380are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16381emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16382generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16383"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16384which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016385frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16386is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016387
16388Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16389slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16390with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16391
16392 Example :
16393 frontend http-in
16394 mode http
16395 option httplog
16396 log global
16397 default_backend bck
16398
16399 backend static
16400 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16401
16402 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16403 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16404 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016405 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016406
16407 Field Format Extract from the example above
16408 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16409 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016410 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016411 4 frontend_name http-in
16412 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016413 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016414 7 status_code 200
16415 8 bytes_read* 2750
16416 9 captured_request_cookie -
16417 10 captured_response_cookie -
16418 11 termination_state ----
16419 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16420 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16421 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16422 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16423 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016424
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016425Detailed fields description :
16426 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016427 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16428 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16429 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016430 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016431 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016432 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016433
16434 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016435 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16436 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16437 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016438
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016439 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16440 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016441
16442 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16443 and processed the connection.
16444
16445 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16446 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16447 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16448
16449 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16450 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16451 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16452 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16453 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16454 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16455
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016456 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16457 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16458 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
16459 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
16460 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16461 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016462 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16463 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016464
16465 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16466 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016467 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016468
16469 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16470 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016471 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16472 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016473
16474 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16475 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16476 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16477 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16478 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016479 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16480 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016481
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016482 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16483 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16484 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16485 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16486 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16487 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16488 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016489 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016490
16491 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16492 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16493 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16494
16495 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16496 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
16497 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
16498 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16499 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16500 overflowing.
16501
16502 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16503 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16504 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16505 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16506 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16507 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16508 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16509 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16510
16511 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16512 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16513 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16514 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16515 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16516 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16517 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16518 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16519
16520 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16521 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16522 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16523 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16524 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16525 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16526 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16527
16528 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016529 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016530 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16531 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16532 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016533 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016534 system.
16535
16536 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16537 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16538 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16539 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16540 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16541 caused by a denial of service attack.
16542
16543 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16544 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16545 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16546 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16547 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16548 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16549 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16550 denial of service attack.
16551
16552 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16553 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16554 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16555 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16556 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16557 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16558 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16559 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16560 processed than on other servers.
16561
16562 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16563 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16564 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16565 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16566 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16567 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16568 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16569 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16570 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16571 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16572 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16573 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16574 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16575
16576 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16577 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16578 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16579 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16580 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16581 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016582 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016583 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16584
16585 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16586 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16587 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16588 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16589 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16590 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016591 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016592 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16593 occurs.
16594
16595 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16596 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16597 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16598 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16599 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16600 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16601 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16602 cookies" below for more details.
16603
16604 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16605 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16606 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16607 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16608 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
16609 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
16610 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
16611 and cookies" below for more details.
16612
16613 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
16614 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
16615 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
16616 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
16617 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
16618 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
16619 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
16620 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
16621
16622
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200166238.2.4. Custom log format
16624------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016625
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016626The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016627mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016628
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016629HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016630Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
16631separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
16632prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
16633
16634Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
16635variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016636("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016637
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016638If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020016639as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016640less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
16641the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
16642
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016643Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016644In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010016645in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016646
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016647Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
16648'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
16649https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
16650such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
16651
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016652Flags are :
16653 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016654 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016655 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
16656 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016657
16658 Example:
16659
16660 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
16661 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
16662
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016663 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
16664
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016665At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
16666
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016667 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
16668 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016669
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016670the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016671
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016672 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
16673 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
16674 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016675
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016676and the default TCP format is defined this way :
16677
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016678 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
16679 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016680
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016681Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
16682
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016683 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016684 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016685 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
16686 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
16687 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016688 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
16689 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
16690 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016691 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016692 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
16693 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000016694 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016695 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
16696 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010016697 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020016698 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016699 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016700 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016701 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020016702 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080016703 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016704 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
16705 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
16706 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
16707 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
16708 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016709 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016710 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
16711 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016712 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016713 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
16714 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016715 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16716 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
16717 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016718 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016719 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
16720 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016721 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016722 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16723 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
16724 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020016725 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020016726 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016727 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
16728 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
16729 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
16730 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020016731 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016732 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016733 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016734 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010016735 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016736 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016737 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
16738 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
16739 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016740 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016741 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
16742 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016743 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016744 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
16745 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020016746 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016747 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016748 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016749 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016750
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016751 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016752
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016753
167548.2.5. Error log format
16755-----------------------
16756
16757When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
16758protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
16759By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
16760"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016761will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016762logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
16763
16764The format looks like this :
16765
16766 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
16767 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
16768 Connection error during SSL handshake
16769
16770 Field Format Extract from the example above
16771 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
16772 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
16773 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
16774 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
16775 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
16776
16777These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
16778failures.
16779
16780
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167818.3. Advanced logging options
16782-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016783
16784Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
16785just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
16786options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
16787for more information about their usage.
16788
16789
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167908.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
16791------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016792
16793It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
16794haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
16795commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
16796monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
16797ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
16798
16799 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
16800 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
16801 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
16802 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
16803
16804 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
16805 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
16806 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016807 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016808 such as other load-balancers.
16809
16810 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
16811 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
16812 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
16813
16814
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168158.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
16816----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016817
16818The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
16819what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
16820or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016821"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016822just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
16823log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
16824after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
16825is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
16826with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
16827with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
16828
16829
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168308.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
16831------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016832
16833Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
16834for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
16835"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
16836retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
16837raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
16838a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
16839file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
16840you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
16841"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
16842
16843
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168448.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
16845--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016846
16847Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
16848multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
16849them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
16850"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
16851logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
16852error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
16853and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
16854too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
16855useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
16856alternative.
16857
16858
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168598.4. Timing events
16860------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016861
16862Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
16863reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
16864the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
16865frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016866mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
16867addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
16868
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010016869Timings events in HTTP mode:
16870
16871 first request 2nd request
16872 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
16873 t tr t tr ...
16874 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
16875 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
16876 :<---- Tq ---->: :
16877 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
16878 :<--------- Ta --------->:
16879
16880Timings events in TCP mode:
16881
16882 TCP session
16883 |<----------------->|
16884 t t
16885 ---|----|----|----|----|---
16886 | Th Tw Tc Td |
16887 |<------ Tt ------->|
16888
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016889 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016890 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016891 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
16892 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
16893 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016894 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016895 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
16896 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
16897 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
16898 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016899
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016900 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
16901 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
16902 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016903 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
16904 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
16905 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
16906 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
16907 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
16908 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016909
16910 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
16911 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
16912 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
16913 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
16914 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
16915 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
16916 request typed by hand during a test.
16917
16918 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
16919 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016920 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016921 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
16922 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
16923 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
16924 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016925
16926 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
16927 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
16928 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
16929 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
16930 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
16931
16932 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
16933 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
16934 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
16935 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
16936 connection never established.
16937
16938 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
16939 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
16940 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
16941 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
16942 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
16943 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
16944 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
16945 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
16946 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
16947 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
16948 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
16949
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016950 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
16951 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
16952 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
16953 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
16954 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
16955 by subtracting other timers when valid :
16956
16957 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
16958
16959 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
16960 "Ta" can never be negative.
16961
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016962 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
16963 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016964 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
16965 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016966 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016967
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016968 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016969
16970 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016971 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
16972 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016973
16974These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
16975protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
16976that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016977due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
16978"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
16979that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016980
16981Most common cases :
16982
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016983 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
16984 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
16985 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
16986 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
16987 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
16988 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
16989 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
16990 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
16991 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
16992 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
16993 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020016994 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016995
16996 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
16997 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
16998 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
16999 of ms on remote networks.
17000
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017001 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17002 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17003 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017004
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017005 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17006 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17007 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17008 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17009 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17010 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17011 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17012 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17013 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017014
17015Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17016
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017017 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017018 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017019 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017020
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017021 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017022 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17023 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17024
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017025 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017026 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17027 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17028 flags.
17029
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017030 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17031 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017032 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17033 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17034 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17035 the client connection was maintained open.
17036
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017037 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017038 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017039 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017040 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17041
17042
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170438.5. Session state at disconnection
17044-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017045
17046TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17047"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
170482-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17049each of which has a special meaning :
17050
17051 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17052 session to terminate :
17053
17054 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17055
17056 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17057 server explicitly refused it.
17058
17059 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17060 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17061 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17062 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017063 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017064
17065 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17066 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017067
17068 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17069 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17070 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17071 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17072 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17073
17074 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17075 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17076 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17077 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17078 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17079
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017080 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17081 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17082
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017083 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17084 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17085 backup connections when going up.
17086
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017087 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17088
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017089 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17090 send or receive data.
17091
17092 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17093 send or receive data.
17094
17095 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17096 with nothing left in the buffers.
17097
17098 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17099
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017100 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017101 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17102
17103 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17104 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17105 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17106 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17107 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17108
17109 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17110 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17111
17112 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17113 server (HTTP only).
17114
17115 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17116
17117 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17118 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17119 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17120
17121 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17122 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17123 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17124
17125 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17126
17127 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17128 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17129
17130 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17131 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17132 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17133
17134 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17135 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017136 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17137 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017138
17139 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17140 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17141 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17142 another server.
17143
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017144 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017145 server.
17146
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017147 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17148 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17149 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17150 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17151
17152 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17153 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17154 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17155 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17156
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017157 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17158 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17159 "use-server" rule).
17160
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017161 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17162
17163 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17164 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17165
17166 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17167
17168 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17169 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17170 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17171
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017172 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17173 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017174 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017175 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17176 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17177
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017178 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17179
17180 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17181 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17182
17183 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17184
17185 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17186
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017187The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17188was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017189helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17190starvation, attacks, etc...
17191
17192The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17193alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17194easier finding and understanding.
17195
17196 Flags Reason
17197
17198 -- Normal termination.
17199
17200 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17201 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17202 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17203 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17204
17205 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17206 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17207 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17208 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17209 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17210 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017211
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017212 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17213 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017214 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017215
17216 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17217 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17218 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17219
17220 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17221 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17222 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17223 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17224 the server takes too long to respond.
17225
17226 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17227 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17228 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17229 long a time to respond.
17230
17231 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17232 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17233 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17234 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017235 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17236 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017237
17238 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17239 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17240 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17241 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17242 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017243 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017244 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17245 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17246 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17247 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17248 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17249 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17250 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17251 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017252 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017253 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17254 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17255 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017256
17257 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17258 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017259 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17260 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17261 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17262 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017263
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017264 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17265 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17266
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017267 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017268 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17269 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017270 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017271 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17272 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17273
17274 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17275 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17276 503 or 504 here.
17277
17278 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17279 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17280 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17281 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17282 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17283
17284 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17285 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017286 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017287 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17288 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17289
17290 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17291 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17292 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17293 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17294 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17295 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17296 between haproxy and the server.
17297
17298 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17299 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17300 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17301 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17302 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17303 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17304 solution is to fix the application.
17305
17306 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17307 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17308 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17309 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17310 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17311 external attacks.
17312
17313 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17314 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017315 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017316 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17317 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17318
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017319 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17320 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17321 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017322 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017323 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017324
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017325 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17326 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17327 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17328 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017329 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17330 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17331 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17332 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17333 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017334
17335 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17336 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17337 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17338 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17339
17340 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17341 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17342 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17343 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17344
17345 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17346 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17347 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17348 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17349
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017350The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17351persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17352important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17353re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17354
17355 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17356
17357 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17358 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17359 set on a GET request.
17360
17361 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17362 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017363 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017364 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17365
17366 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17367 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17368 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17369
17370 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17371 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17372 already got a cookie.
17373
17374 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17375 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17376 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17377 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17378 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17379
17380 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17381 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17382 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17383
17384 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17385 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17386 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17387
17388 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17389 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17390
17391 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17392 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17393 then advertised in the response.
17394
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017395
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173968.6. Non-printable characters
17397-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017398
17399In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17400consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17401converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17402prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17403being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17404escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17405is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17406'}' when logging headers.
17407
17408Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17409issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17410containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17411
17412Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17413the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17414performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17415
17416
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174178.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17418---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017419
17420Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17421achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017422section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017423cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17424the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17425the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017426locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017427not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17428user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17429a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17430wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17431
17432 Examples :
17433 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17434 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17435
17436 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17437 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17438
17439
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174408.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17441---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017442
17443Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17444proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17445the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17446server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17447
17448Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17449response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017450section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017451
17452It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017453time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17454appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017455are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17456and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17457follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17458request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17459in the logs.
17460
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017461As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17462frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17463an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17464
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017465 Example :
17466 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17467 listen proxy-out
17468 mode http
17469 option httplog
17470 option logasap
17471 log global
17472 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17473
17474 # log the name of the virtual server
17475 capture request header Host len 20
17476
17477 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17478 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17479
17480 # log the beginning of the referrer
17481 capture request header Referer len 20
17482
17483 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17484 capture response header Server len 20
17485
17486 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17487 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17488
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017489 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017490 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17491
17492 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17493 capture response header Via len 20
17494
17495 # log the URL location during a redirection
17496 capture response header Location len 20
17497
17498 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17499 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17500 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17501 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17502 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17503
17504 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17505 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17506 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17507 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017508 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017509
17510 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17511 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17512 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17513 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17514 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017515 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017516
17517
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175188.9. Examples of logs
17519---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017520
17521These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17522them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17523reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17524
17525 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17526 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17527 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17528
17529 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17530 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17531
17532 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17533 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17534 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17535
17536 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17537 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17538
17539 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17540 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17541 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17542
17543 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017544 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017545 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17546 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17547
17548 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17549 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17550 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17551
17552 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
17553 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020017554 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017555 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
17556 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
17557 to return the 502 and not the server.
17558
17559 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017560 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017561
17562 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17563 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17564 Nothing was sent to any server.
17565
17566 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17567 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17568
17569 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17570 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017571 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017572 send a 408 return code to the client.
17573
17574 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17575 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17576
17577 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17578 5 seconds ("c----").
17579
17580 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17581 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017582 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017583
17584 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017585 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017586 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17587 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17588 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17589 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17590 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017591
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017592
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200175939. Supported filters
17594--------------------
17595
17596Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17597accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17598unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17599
17600See also : "filter"
17601
176029.1. Trace
17603----------
17604
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017605filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017606
17607 Arguments:
17608 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
17609 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
17610
17611 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
17612 the client and the server. By default, this filter
17613 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
17614 only parses a random amount of the available data.
17615
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017616 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017617 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
17618 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
17619 amount of the parsed data.
17620
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017621 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017622
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017623This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
17624callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
17625information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
17626filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
17627
17628Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
17629tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
17630a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
17631
17632
176339.2. HTTP compression
17634---------------------
17635
17636filter compression
17637
17638The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
17639keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
17640when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
17641use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
17642used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
17643filters evaluation order.
17644
17645See also : "compression"
17646
17647
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200176489.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
17649--------------------------------------------
17650
17651filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
17652
17653 Arguments :
17654
17655 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
17656 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
17657 parsed.
17658
17659 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
17660 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
17661 part must be placed in its own scope.
17662
17663The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
17664external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017665streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017666exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
17667also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
17668
17669SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
17670the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
17671
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017672For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017673"doc/SPOE.txt".
17674
17675Important note:
17676 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
17677 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
17678
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001767910. Cache
17680---------
17681
17682HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
17683(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
17684RAM.
17685
17686The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017687this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017688
17689If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
17690independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
17691when we try to allocate a new one.
17692
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017693The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017694
17695It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
17696"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
17697for more details.
17698
17699When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
17700replaced by "<CACHE>".
17701
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001770210.1. Limitation
17703----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017704
17705The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
17706
17707- If the response is not a 200
17708- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020017709- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017710- If the response is not cacheable
17711
17712- If the request is not a GET
17713- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020017714- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017715
17716Caution!: Due to the current limitation of the filters, it is not recommended
17717to use the cache with other filters. Using them can cause undefined behavior
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017718if they modify the response (compression for example).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017719
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001772010.2. Setup
17721-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017722
17723To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
17724the corresponding http-request and response actions.
17725
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001772610.2.1. Cache section
17727---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017728
17729cache <name>
17730 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
17731 size of cache is mandatory.
17732
17733total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017734 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020017735 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017736
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020017737max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020017738 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
17739 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
17740 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020017741
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017742max-age <seconds>
17743 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
17744 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
17745 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
17746 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
17747 default.
17748
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001774910.2.2. Proxy section
17750---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017751
17752http-request cache-use <name>
17753 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
17754 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
17755 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
17756 after this one.
17757
17758http-response cache-store <name>
17759 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
17760 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
17761 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
17762 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
17763
17764
17765Example:
17766
17767 backend bck1
17768 mode http
17769
17770 http-request cache-use foobar
17771 http-response cache-store foobar
17772 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
17773
17774 cache foobar
17775 total-max-size 4
17776 max-age 240
17777
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017778/*
17779 * Local variables:
17780 * fill-column: 79
17781 * End:
17782 */